summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/old
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:20:50 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:20:50 -0700
commit6339a8ef0ba17a4bf9233b168616744198872099 (patch)
tree21d115f5ce9d651eaf51938d663987d517da0f79 /old
initial commit of ebook 3261HEADmain
Diffstat (limited to 'old')
-rw-r--r--old/nwsnw10.txt8446
-rw-r--r--old/nwsnw10.zipbin0 -> 168067 bytes
2 files changed, 8446 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/old/nwsnw10.txt b/old/nwsnw10.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..82812b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/nwsnw10.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,8446 @@
+Project Gutenberg Etext of News from Nowhere, by William Morris
+#8 in our series by William Morris
+
+Copyright laws are changing all over the world, be sure to check
+the laws for your country before redistributing these files!!!
+
+Please take a look at the important information in this header.
+We encourage you to keep this file on your own disk, keeping an
+electronic path open for the next readers.
+
+Please do not remove this.
+
+This should be the first thing seen when anyone opens the book.
+Do not change or edit it without written permission. The words
+are carefully chosen to provide users with the information they
+need about what they can legally do with the texts.
+
+
+**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
+
+**Etexts Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
+
+*These Etexts Prepared By Hundreds of Volunteers and Donations*
+
+Information on contacting Project Gutenberg to get Etexts, and
+further information is included below. We need your donations.
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a 501(c)(3)
+organization with EIN [Employee Identification Number] 64-6221541
+
+As of 12/12/00 contributions are only being solicited from people in:
+Colorado, Connecticut, Idaho, Indiana, Iowa,
+Kentucky, Louisiana, Massachusetts, Montana,
+Nevada, Oklahoma, South Carolina, South Dakota,
+Texas, Vermont, and Wyoming.
+
+As the requirements for other states are met,
+additions to this list will be made and fund raising
+will begin in the additional states. Please feel
+free to ask to check the status of your state.
+
+These donations should be made to:
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+PMB 113
+1739 University Ave.
+Oxford, MS 38655-4109
+
+
+Title: News from Nowhere
+
+Author: William Morris
+
+Release Date: June, 2002 [Etext #3261]
+[Yes, we are about one year ahead of schedule]
+[The actual date this file first posted = 03/02/01]
+
+Edition: 10
+
+Language: English
+
+Project Gutenberg Etext of News from Nowhere, by William Morris
+*****This file should be named nwsnw10.txt or nwsnw10.zip******
+
+Corrected EDITIONS of our etexts get a new NUMBER, nwsnw11.txt
+VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, nwsnw10a.txt
+
+This etext was produced from the 1908 Longmans, Green, and Co.
+edition by David Price, email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk
+
+Project Gutenberg Etexts are usually created from multiple editions,
+all of which are in the Public Domain in the United States, unless a
+copyright notice is included. Therefore, we usually do NOT keep any
+of these books in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+We are now trying to release all our books one year in advance
+of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing.
+Please be encouraged to send us error messages even years after
+the official publication date.
+
+Please note: neither this list nor its contents are final till
+midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement.
+The official release date of all Project Gutenberg Etexts is at
+Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
+preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
+and editing by those who wish to do so.
+
+Most people start at our sites at:
+http://gutenberg.net
+http://promo.net/pg
+
+
+Those of you who want to download any Etext before announcement
+can surf to them as follows, and just download by date; this is
+also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the
+indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an
+announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter.
+
+http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext02
+or
+ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext02
+
+Or /etext01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90
+
+Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want,
+as it appears in our Newsletters.
+
+
+Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
+
+We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
+time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours
+to get any etext selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
+searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. This
+projected audience is one hundred million readers. If our value
+per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2
+million dollars per hour this year as we release fifty new Etext
+files per month, or 500 more Etexts in 2000 for a total of 3000+
+If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total
+should reach over 300 billion Etexts given away by year's end.
+
+The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away One Trillion Etext
+Files by December 31, 2001. [10,000 x 100,000,000 = 1 Trillion]
+This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
+which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users.
+
+At our revised rates of production, we will reach only one-third
+of that goal by the end of 2001, or about 3,333 Etexts unless we
+manage to get some real funding.
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created
+to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+Presently, contributions are only being solicited from people in:
+Colorado, Connecticut, Idaho, Indiana, Iowa,
+Kentucky, Louisiana, Massachusetts, Nevada,
+Montana, Nevada, Oklahoma, South Carolina,
+South Dakota, Texas, Vermont, and Wyoming.
+
+As the requirements for other states are met,
+additions to this list will be made and fund raising
+will begin in the additional states.
+
+These donations should be made to:
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+PMB 113
+1739 University Ave.
+Oxford, MS 38655-4109
+
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation,
+EIN [Employee Identification Number] 64-6221541,
+has been approved as a 501(c)(3) organization by the US Internal
+Revenue Service (IRS). Donations are tax-deductible to the extent
+permitted by law. As the requirements for other states are met,
+additions to this list will be made and fund raising will begin in the
+additional states.
+
+All donations should be made to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation. Mail to:
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+PMB 113
+1739 University Avenue
+Oxford, MS 38655-4109 [USA]
+
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+You can get up to date donation information at:
+
+http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html
+
+
+***
+
+If you can't reach Project Gutenberg,
+you can always email directly to:
+
+Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com>
+
+hart@pobox.com forwards to hart@prairienet.org and archive.org
+if your mail bounces from archive.org, I will still see it, if
+it bounces from prairienet.org, better resend later on. . . .
+
+Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message.
+
+We would prefer to send you information by email.
+
+
+***
+
+
+Example command-line FTP session:
+
+ftp ftp.ibiblio.org
+login: anonymous
+password: your@login
+cd pub/docs/books/gutenberg
+cd etext90 through etext99 or etext00 through etext02, etc.
+dir [to see files]
+get or mget [to get files. . .set bin for zip files]
+GET GUTINDEX.?? [to get a year's listing of books, e.g., GUTINDEX.99]
+GET GUTINDEX.ALL [to get a listing of ALL books]
+
+
+**The Legal Small Print**
+
+
+(Three Pages)
+
+***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS**START***
+Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
+They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
+your copy of this etext, even if you got it for free from
+someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
+fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
+disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
+you may distribute copies of this etext if you want to.
+
+*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS ETEXT
+By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+etext, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
+this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
+a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this etext by
+sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
+you got it from. If you received this etext on a physical
+medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
+
+ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM ETEXTS
+This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etexts,
+is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart
+through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project").
+Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
+on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
+distribute it in the United States without permission and
+without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
+below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this etext
+under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
+
+Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market
+any commercial products without permission.
+
+To create these etexts, the Project expends considerable
+efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
+works. Despite these efforts, the Project's etexts and any
+medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
+things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
+disk or other etext medium, a computer virus, or computer
+codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
+But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
+[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may
+receive this etext from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext) disclaims
+all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
+UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
+INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
+OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+If you discover a Defect in this etext within 90 days of
+receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
+you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
+time to the person you received it from. If you received it
+on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
+such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
+copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
+choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
+receive it electronically.
+
+THIS ETEXT IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
+TO THE ETEXT OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
+PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
+
+Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
+the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
+above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
+may have other legal rights.
+
+INDEMNITY
+You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation,
+and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated
+with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
+texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including
+legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the
+following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this etext,
+[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the etext,
+or [3] any Defect.
+
+DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
+You may distribute copies of this etext electronically, or by
+disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
+"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
+or:
+
+[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
+ requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
+ etext or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
+ if you wish, distribute this etext in machine readable
+ binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
+ including any form resulting from conversion by word
+ processing or hypertext software, but only so long as
+ *EITHER*:
+
+ [*] The etext, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
+ does *not* contain characters other than those
+ intended by the author of the work, although tilde
+ (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
+ be used to convey punctuation intended by the
+ author, and additional characters may be used to
+ indicate hypertext links; OR
+
+ [*] The etext may be readily converted by the reader at
+ no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
+ form by the program that displays the etext (as is
+ the case, for instance, with most word processors);
+ OR
+
+ [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
+ etext in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
+ or other equivalent proprietary form).
+
+[2] Honor the etext refund and replacement provisions of this
+ "Small Print!" statement.
+
+[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the
+ gross profits you derive calculated using the method you
+ already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
+ don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
+ payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation"
+ the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were
+ legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent
+ periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to
+ let us know your plans and to work out the details.
+
+WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
+Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of
+public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed
+in machine readable form.
+
+The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time,
+public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses.
+Money should be paid to the:
+"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or
+software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at:
+hart@pobox.com
+
+
+
+
+*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS*Ver.12.12.00*END*
+
+
+
+
+
+This etext was produced from the 1908 Longmans, Green, and Co.
+edition by David Price, email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk
+
+
+
+
+
+NEWS FROM NOWHERE
+or AN EPOCH OF REST
+being some chapters from
+A UTOPIAN ROMANCE
+
+by William Morris
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I: DISCUSSION AND BED
+
+
+
+Up at the League, says a friend, there had been one night a brisk
+conversational discussion, as to what would happen on the Morrow of
+the Revolution, finally shading off into a vigorous statement by
+various friends of their views on the future of the fully-developed
+new society.
+
+Says our friend: Considering the subject, the discussion was good-
+tempered; for those present being used to public meetings and after-
+lecture debates, if they did not listen to each others' opinions
+(which could scarcely be expected of them), at all events did not
+always attempt to speak all together, as is the custom of people in
+ordinary polite society when conversing on a subject which interests
+them. For the rest, there were six persons present, and consequently
+six sections of the party were represented, four of which had strong
+but divergent Anarchist opinions. One of the sections, says our
+friend, a man whom he knows very well indeed, sat almost silent at
+the beginning of the discussion, but at last got drawn into it, and
+finished by roaring out very loud, and damning all the rest for
+fools; after which befel a period of noise, and then a lull, during
+which the aforesaid section, having said good-night very amicably,
+took his way home by himself to a western suburb, using the means of
+travelling which civilisation has forced upon us like a habit. As he
+sat in that vapour-bath of hurried and discontented humanity, a
+carriage of the underground railway, he, like others, stewed
+discontentedly, while in self-reproachful mood he turned over the
+many excellent and conclusive arguments which, though they lay at his
+fingers' ends, he had forgotten in the just past discussion. But
+this frame of mind he was so used to, that it didn't last him long,
+and after a brief discomfort, caused by disgust with himself for
+having lost his temper (which he was also well used to), he found
+himself musing on the subject-matter of discussion, but still
+discontentedly and unhappily. "If I could but see a day of it," he
+said to himself; "if I could but see it!"
+
+As he formed the words, the train stopped at his station, five
+minutes' walk from his own house, which stood on the banks of the
+Thames, a little way above an ugly suspension bridge. He went out of
+the station, still discontented and unhappy, muttering "If I could
+but see it! if I could but see it!" but had not gone many steps
+towards the river before (says our friend who tells the story) all
+that discontent and trouble seemed to slip off him.
+
+It was a beautiful night of early winter, the air just sharp enough
+to be refreshing after the hot room and the stinking railway
+carriage. The wind, which had lately turned a point or two north of
+west, had blown the sky clear of all cloud save a light fleck or two
+which went swiftly down the heavens. There was a young moon halfway
+up the sky, and as the home-farer caught sight of it, tangled in the
+branches of a tall old elm, he could scarce bring to his mind the
+shabby London suburb where he was, and he felt as if he were in a
+pleasant country place--pleasanter, indeed, than the deep country was
+as he had known it.
+
+He came right down to the river-side, and lingered a little, looking
+over the low wall to note the moonlit river, near upon high water, go
+swirling and glittering up to Chiswick Eyot: as for the ugly bridge
+below, he did not notice it or think of it, except when for a moment
+(says our friend) it struck him that he missed the row of lights down
+stream. Then he turned to his house door and let himself in; and
+even as he shut the door to, disappeared all remembrance of that
+brilliant logic and foresight which had so illuminated the recent
+discussion; and of the discussion itself there remained no trace,
+save a vague hope, that was now become a pleasure, for days of peace
+and rest, and cleanness and smiling goodwill.
+
+In this mood he tumbled into bed, and fell asleep after his wont, in
+two minutes' time; but (contrary to his wont) woke up again not long
+after in that curiously wide-awake condition which sometimes
+surprises even good sleepers; a condition under which we feel all our
+wits preternaturally sharpened, while all the miserable muddles we
+have ever got into, all the disgraces and losses of our lives, will
+insist on thrusting themselves forward for the consideration of those
+sharpened wits.
+
+In this state he lay (says our friend) till he had almost begun to
+enjoy it: till the tale of his stupidities amused him, and the
+entanglements before him, which he saw so clearly, began to shape
+themselves into an amusing story for him.
+
+He heard one o'clock strike, then two and then three; after which he
+fell asleep again. Our friend says that from that sleep he awoke
+once more, and afterwards went through such surprising adventures
+that he thinks that they should be told to our comrades, and indeed
+the public in general, and therefore proposes to tell them now. But,
+says he, I think it would be better if I told them in the first
+person, as if it were myself who had gone through them; which,
+indeed, will be the easier and more natural to me, since I understand
+the feelings and desires of the comrade of whom I am telling better
+than any one else in the world does.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II: A MORNING BATH
+
+
+
+Well, I awoke, and found that I had kicked my bedclothes off; and no
+wonder, for it was hot and the sun shining brightly. I jumped up and
+washed and hurried on my clothes, but in a hazy and half-awake
+condition, as if I had slept for a long, long while, and could not
+shake off the weight of slumber. In fact, I rather took it for
+granted that I was at home in my own room than saw that it was so.
+
+When I was dressed, I felt the place so hot that I made haste to get
+out of the room and out of the house; and my first feeling was a
+delicious relief caused by the fresh air and pleasant breeze; my
+second, as I began to gather my wits together, mere measureless
+wonder: for it was winter when I went to bed the last night, and
+now, by witness of the river-side trees, it was summer, a beautiful
+bright morning seemingly of early June. However, there was still the
+Thames sparkling under the sun, and near high water, as last night I
+had seen it gleaming under the moon.
+
+I had by no means shaken off the feeling of oppression, and wherever
+I might have been should scarce have been quite conscious of the
+place; so it was no wonder that I felt rather puzzled in despite of
+the familiar face of the Thames. Withal I felt dizzy and queer; and
+remembering that people often got a boat and had a swim in mid-
+stream, I thought I would do no less. It seems very early, quoth I
+to myself, but I daresay I shall find someone at Biffin's to take me.
+However, I didn't get as far as Biffin's, or even turn to my left
+thitherward, because just then I began to see that there was a
+landing-stage right before me in front of my house: in fact, on the
+place where my next-door neighbour had rigged one up, though somehow
+it didn't look like that either. Down I went on to it, and sure
+enough among the empty boats moored to it lay a man on his sculls in
+a solid-looking tub of a boat clearly meant for bathers. He nodded
+to me, and bade me good-morning as if he expected me, so I jumped in
+without any words, and he paddled away quietly as I peeled for my
+swim. As we went, I looked down on the water, and couldn't help
+saying -
+
+"How clear the water is this morning!"
+
+"Is it?" said he; "I didn't notice it. You know the flood-tide
+always thickens it a bit."
+
+"H'm," said I, "I have seen it pretty muddy even at half-ebb."
+
+He said nothing in answer, but seemed rather astonished; and as he
+now lay just stemming the tide, and I had my clothes off, I jumped in
+without more ado. Of course when I had my head above water again I
+turned towards the tide, and my eyes naturally sought for the bridge,
+and so utterly astonished was I by what I saw, that I forgot to
+strike out, and went spluttering under water again, and when I came
+up made straight for the boat; for I felt that I must ask some
+questions of my waterman, so bewildering had been the half-sight I
+had seen from the face of the river with the water hardly out of my
+eyes; though by this time I was quit of the slumbrous and dizzy
+feeling, and was wide-awake and clear-headed.
+
+As I got in up the steps which he had lowered, and he held out his
+hand to help me, we went drifting speedily up towards Chiswick; but
+now he caught up the sculls and brought her head round again, and
+said--"A short swim, neighbour; but perhaps you find the water cold
+this morning, after your journey. Shall I put you ashore at once, or
+would you like to go down to Putney before breakfast?"
+
+He spoke in a way so unlike what I should have expected from a
+Hammersmith waterman, that I stared at him, as I answered, "Please to
+hold her a little; I want to look about me a bit."
+
+"All right," he said; "it's no less pretty in its way here than it is
+off Barn Elms; it's jolly everywhere this time in the morning. I'm
+glad you got up early; it's barely five o'clock yet."
+
+If I was astonished with my sight of the river banks, I was no less
+astonished at my waterman, now that I had time to look at him and see
+him with my head and eyes clear.
+
+He was a handsome young fellow, with a peculiarly pleasant and
+friendly look about his eyes,--an expression which was quite new to
+me then, though I soon became familiar with it. For the rest, he was
+dark-haired and berry-brown of skin, well-knit and strong, and
+obviously used to exercising his muscles, but with nothing rough or
+coarse about him, and clean as might be. His dress was not like any
+modern work-a-day clothes I had seen, but would have served very well
+as a costume for a picture of fourteenth century life: it was of
+dark blue cloth, simple enough, but of fine web, and without a stain
+on it. He had a brown leather belt round his waist, and I noticed
+that its clasp was of damascened steel beautifully wrought. In
+short, he seemed to be like some specially manly and refined young
+gentleman, playing waterman for a spree, and I concluded that this
+was the case.
+
+I felt that I must make some conversation; so I pointed to the Surrey
+bank, where I noticed some light plank stages running down the
+foreshore, with windlasses at the landward end of them, and said,
+"What are they doing with those things here? If we were on the Tay,
+I should have said that they were for drawing the salmon nets; but
+here--"
+
+"Well," said he, smiling, "of course that is what they ARE for.
+Where there are salmon, there are likely to be salmon-nets, Tay or
+Thames; but of course they are not always in use; we don't want
+salmon EVERY day of the season."
+
+I was going to say, "But is this the Thames?" but held my peace in my
+wonder, and turned my bewildered eyes eastward to look at the bridge
+again, and thence to the shores of the London river; and surely there
+was enough to astonish me. For though there was a bridge across the
+stream and houses on its banks, how all was changed from last night!
+The soap-works with their smoke-vomiting chimneys were gone; the
+engineer's works gone; the lead-works gone; and no sound of rivetting
+and hammering came down the west wind from Thorneycroft's. Then the
+bridge! I had perhaps dreamed of such a bridge, but never seen such
+an one out of an illuminated manuscript; for not even the Ponte
+Vecchio at Florence came anywhere near it. It was of stone arches,
+splendidly solid, and as graceful as they were strong; high enough
+also to let ordinary river traffic through easily. Over the parapet
+showed quaint and fanciful little buildings, which I supposed to be
+booths or shops, beset with painted and gilded vanes and spirelets.
+The stone was a little weathered, but showed no marks of the grimy
+sootiness which I was used to on every London building more than a
+year old. In short, to me a wonder of a bridge.
+
+The sculler noted my eager astonished look, and said, as if in answer
+to my thoughts -
+
+"Yes, it IS a pretty bridge, isn't it? Even the up-stream bridges,
+which are so much smaller, are scarcely daintier, and the down-stream
+ones are scarcely more dignified and stately."
+
+I found myself saying, almost against my will, "How old is it?"
+
+"Oh, not very old," he said; "it was built or at least opened, in
+2003. There used to be a rather plain timber bridge before then."
+
+The date shut my mouth as if a key had been turned in a padlock fixed
+to my lips; for I saw that something inexplicable had happened, and
+that if I said much, I should be mixed up in a game of cross
+questions and crooked answers. So I tried to look unconcerned, and
+to glance in a matter-of-course way at the banks of the river, though
+this is what I saw up to the bridge and a little beyond; say as far
+as the site of the soap-works. Both shores had a line of very pretty
+houses, low and not large, standing back a little way from the river;
+they were mostly built of red brick and roofed with tiles, and
+looked, above all, comfortable, and as if they were, so to say,
+alive, and sympathetic with the life of the dwellers in them. There
+was a continuous garden in front of them, going down to the water's
+edge, in which the flowers were now blooming luxuriantly, and sending
+delicious waves of summer scent over the eddying stream. Behind the
+houses, I could see great trees rising, mostly planes, and looking
+down the water there were the reaches towards Putney almost as if
+they were a lake with a forest shore, so thick were the big trees;
+and I said aloud, but as if to myself -
+
+"Well, I'm glad that they have not built over Barn Elms."
+
+I blushed for my fatuity as the words slipped out of my mouth, and my
+companion looked at me with a half smile which I thought I
+understood; so to hide my confusion I said, "Please take me ashore
+now: I want to get my breakfast."
+
+He nodded, and brought her head round with a sharp stroke, and in a
+trice we were at the landing-stage again. He jumped out and I
+followed him; and of course I was not surprised to see him wait, as
+if for the inevitable after-piece that follows the doing of a service
+to a fellow-citizen. So I put my hand into my waistcoat-pocket, and
+said, "How much?" though still with the uncomfortable feeling that
+perhaps I was offering money to a gentleman.
+
+He looked puzzled, and said, "How much? I don't quite understand
+what you are asking about. Do you mean the tide? If so, it is close
+on the turn now."
+
+I blushed, and said, stammering, "Please don't take it amiss if I ask
+you; I mean no offence: but what ought I to pay you? You see I am a
+stranger, and don't know your customs--or your coins."
+
+And therewith I took a handful of money out of my pocket, as one does
+in a foreign country. And by the way, I saw that the silver had
+oxydised, and was like a blackleaded stove in colour.
+
+He still seemed puzzled, but not at all offended; and he looked at
+the coins with some curiosity. I thought, Well after all, he IS a
+waterman, and is considering what he may venture to take. He seems
+such a nice fellow that I'm sure I don't grudge him a little over-
+payment. I wonder, by the way, whether I couldn't hire him as a
+guide for a day or two, since he is so intelligent.
+
+Therewith my new friend said thoughtfully:
+
+"I think I know what you mean. You think that I have done you a
+service; so you feel yourself bound to give me something which I am
+not to give to a neighbour, unless he has done something special for
+me. I have heard of this kind of thing; but pardon me for saying,
+that it seems to us a troublesome and roundabout custom; and we don't
+know how to manage it. And you see this ferrying and giving people
+casts about the water is my BUSINESS, which I would do for anybody;
+so to take gifts in connection with it would look very queer.
+Besides, if one person gave me something, then another might, and
+another, and so on; and I hope you won't think me rude if I say that
+I shouldn't know where to stow away so many mementos of friendship."
+
+And he laughed loud and merrily, as if the idea of being paid for his
+work was a very funny joke. I confess I began to be afraid that the
+man was mad, though he looked sane enough; and I was rather glad to
+think that I was a good swimmer, since we were so close to a deep
+swift stream. However, he went on by no means like a madman:
+
+"As to your coins, they are curious, but not very old; they seem to
+be all of the reign of Victoria; you might give them to some
+scantily-furnished museum. Ours has enough of such coins, besides a
+fair number of earlier ones, many of which are beautiful, whereas
+these nineteenth century ones are so beastly ugly, ain't they? We
+have a piece of Edward III., with the king in a ship, and little
+leopards and fleurs-de-lys all along the gunwale, so delicately
+worked. You see," he said, with something of a smirk, "I am fond of
+working in gold and fine metals; this buckle here is an early piece
+of mine."
+
+No doubt I looked a little shy of him under the influence of that
+doubt as to his sanity. So he broke off short, and said in a kind
+voice:
+
+"But I see that I am boring you, and I ask your pardon. For, not to
+mince matters, I can tell that you ARE a stranger, and must come from
+a place very unlike England. But also it is clear that it won't do
+to overdose you with information about this place, and that you had
+best suck it in little by little. Further, I should take it as very
+kind in you if you would allow me to be the showman of our new world
+to you, since you have stumbled on me first. Though indeed it will
+be a mere kindness on your part, for almost anybody would make as
+good a guide, and many much better."
+
+There certainly seemed no flavour in him of Colney Hatch; and besides
+I thought I could easily shake him off if it turned out that he
+really was mad; so I said:
+
+"It is a very kind offer, but it is difficult for me to accept it,
+unless--" I was going to say, Unless you will let me pay you
+properly; but fearing to stir up Colney Hatch again, I changed the
+sentence into, "I fear I shall be taking you away from your work--or
+your amusement."
+
+"O," he said, "don't trouble about that, because it will give me an
+opportunity of doing a good turn to a friend of mine, who wants to
+take my work here. He is a weaver from Yorkshire, who has rather
+overdone himself between his weaving and his mathematics, both indoor
+work, you see; and being a great friend of mine, he naturally came to
+me to get him some outdoor work. If you think you can put up with
+me, pray take me as your guide."
+
+He added presently: "It is true that I have promised to go up-stream
+to some special friends of mine, for the hay-harvest; but they won't
+be ready for us for more than a week: and besides, you might go with
+me, you know, and see some very nice people, besides making notes of
+our ways in Oxfordshire. You could hardly do better if you want to
+see the country."
+
+I felt myself obliged to thank him, whatever might come of it; and he
+added eagerly:
+
+"Well, then, that's settled. I will give my friend call; he is
+living in the Guest House like you, and if he isn't up yet, he ought
+to be this fine summer morning."
+
+Therewith he took a little silver bugle-horn from his girdle and blew
+two or three sharp but agreeable notes on it; and presently from the
+house which stood on the site of my old dwelling (of which more
+hereafter) another young man came sauntering towards us. He was not
+so well-looking or so strongly made as my sculler friend, being
+sandy-haired, rather pale, and not stout-built; but his face was not
+wanting in that happy and friendly expression which I had noticed in
+his friend. As he came up smiling towards us, I saw with pleasure
+that I must give up the Colney Hatch theory as to the waterman, for
+no two madmen ever behaved as they did before a sane man. His dress
+also was of the same cut as the first man's, though somewhat gayer,
+the surcoat being light green with a golden spray embroidered on the
+breast, and his belt being of filagree silver-work.
+
+He gave me good-day very civilly, and greeting his friend joyously,
+said:
+
+"Well, Dick, what is it this morning? Am I to have my work, or
+rather your work? I dreamed last night that we were off up the river
+fishing."
+
+"All right, Bob," said my sculler; "you will drop into my place, and
+if you find it too much, there is George Brightling on the look out
+for a stroke of work, and he lives close handy to you. But see, here
+is a stranger who is willing to amuse me to-day by taking me as his
+guide about our country-side, and you may imagine I don't want to
+lose the opportunity; so you had better take to the boat at once.
+But in any case I shouldn't have kept you out of it for long, since I
+am due in the hay-fields in a few days."
+
+The newcomer rubbed his hands with glee, but turning to me, said in a
+friendly voice:
+
+"Neighbour, both you and friend Dick are lucky, and will have a good
+time to-day, as indeed I shall too. But you had better both come in
+with me at once and get something to eat, lest you should forget your
+dinner in your amusement. I suppose you came into the Guest House
+after I had gone to bed last night?"
+
+I nodded, not caring to enter into a long explanation which would
+have led to nothing, and which in truth by this time I should have
+begun to doubt myself. And we all three turned toward the door of
+the Guest House.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III: THE GUEST HOUSE AND BREAKFAST THEREIN
+
+
+
+I lingered a little behind the others to have a stare at this house,
+which, as I have told you, stood on the site of my old dwelling.
+
+It was a longish building with its gable ends turned away from the
+road, and long traceried windows coming rather low down set in the
+wall that faced us. It was very handsomely built of red brick with a
+lead roof; and high up above the windows there ran a frieze of figure
+subjects in baked clay, very well executed, and designed with a force
+and directness which I had never noticed in modern work before. The
+subjects I recognised at once, and indeed was very particularly
+familiar with them.
+
+However, all this I took in in a minute; for we were presently within
+doors, and standing in a hall with a floor of marble mosaic and an
+open timber roof. There were no windows on the side opposite to the
+river, but arches below leading into chambers, one of which showed a
+glimpse of a garden beyond, and above them a long space of wall gaily
+painted (in fresco, I thought) with similar subjects to those of the
+frieze outside; everything about the place was handsome and
+generously solid as to material; and though it was not very large
+(somewhat smaller than Crosby Hall perhaps), one felt in it that
+exhilarating sense of space and freedom which satisfactory
+architecture always gives to an unanxious man who is in the habit of
+using his eyes.
+
+In this pleasant place, which of course I knew to be the hall of the
+Guest House, three young women were flitting to and fro. As they
+were the first of the sex I had seen on this eventful morning, I
+naturally looked at them very attentively, and found them at least as
+good as the gardens, the architecture, and the male men. As to their
+dress, which of course I took note of, I should say that they were
+decently veiled with drapery, and not bundled up with millinery; that
+they were clothed like women, not upholstered like armchairs, as most
+women of our time are. In short, their dress was somewhat between
+that of the ancient classical costume and the simpler forms of the
+fourteenth century garments, though it was clearly not an imitation
+of either: the materials were light and gay to suit the season. As
+to the women themselves, it was pleasant indeed to see them, they
+were so kind and happy-looking in expression of face, so shapely and
+well-knit of body, and thoroughly healthy-looking and strong. All
+were at least comely, and one of them very handsome and regular of
+feature. They came up to us at once merrily and without the least
+affectation of shyness, and all three shook hands with me as if I
+were a friend newly come back from a long journey: though I could
+not help noticing that they looked askance at my garments; for I had
+on my clothes of last night, and at the best was never a dressy
+person.
+
+A word or two from Robert the weaver, and they bustled about on our
+behoof, and presently came and took us by the hands and led us to a
+table in the pleasantest corner of the hall, where our breakfast was
+spread for us; and, as we sat down, one of them hurried out by the
+chambers aforesaid, and came back again in a little while with a
+great bunch of roses, very different in size and quality to what
+Hammersmith had been wont to grow, but very like the produce of an
+old country garden. She hurried back thence into the buttery, and
+came back once more with a delicately made glass, into which she put
+the flowers and set them down in the midst of our table. One of the
+others, who had run off also, then came back with a big cabbage-leaf
+filled with strawberries, some of them barely ripe, and said as she
+set them on the table, "There, now; I thought of that before I got up
+this morning; but looking at the stranger here getting into your
+boat, Dick, put it out of my head; so that I was not before ALL the
+blackbirds: however, there are a few about as good as you will get
+them anywhere in Hammersmith this morning."
+
+Robert patted her on the head in a friendly manner; and we fell to on
+our breakfast, which was simple enough, but most delicately cooked,
+and set on the table with much daintiness. The bread was
+particularly good, and was of several different kinds, from the big,
+rather close, dark-coloured, sweet-tasting farmhouse loaf, which was
+most to my liking, to the thin pipe-stems of wheaten crust, such as I
+have eaten in Turin.
+
+As I was putting the first mouthfuls into my mouth my eye caught a
+carved and gilded inscription on the panelling, behind what we should
+have called the High Table in an Oxford college hall, and a familiar
+name in it forced me to read it through. Thus it ran:
+
+
+"Guests and neighbours, on the site of this Guest-hall once stood the
+lecture-room of the Hammersmith Socialists. Drink a glass to the
+memory! May 1962."
+
+
+It is difficult to tell you how I felt as I read these words, and I
+suppose my face showed how much I was moved, for both my friends
+looked curiously at me, and there was silence between us for a little
+while.
+
+Presently the weaver, who was scarcely so well mannered a man as the
+ferryman, said to me rather awkwardly:
+
+"Guest, we don't know what to call you: is there any indiscretion in
+asking you your name?"
+
+"Well," said I, "I have some doubts about it myself; so suppose you
+call me Guest, which is a family name, you know, and add William to
+it if you please."
+
+Dick nodded kindly to me; but a shade of anxiousness passed over the
+weaver's face, and he said--"I hope you don't mind my asking, but
+would you tell me where you come from? I am curious about such
+things for good reasons, literary reasons."
+
+Dick was clearly kicking him underneath the table; but he was not
+much abashed, and awaited my answer somewhat eagerly. As for me, I
+was just going to blurt out "Hammersmith," when I bethought me what
+an entanglement of cross purposes that would lead us into; so I took
+time to invent a lie with circumstance, guarded by a little truth,
+and said:
+
+"You see, I have been such a long time away from Europe that things
+seem strange to me now; but I was born and bred on the edge of Epping
+Forest; Walthamstow and Woodford, to wit."
+
+"A pretty place, too," broke in Dick; "a very jolly place, now that
+the trees have had time to grow again since the great clearing of
+houses in 1955."
+
+Quoth the irrepressible weaver: "Dear neighbour, since you knew the
+Forest some time ago, could you tell me what truth there is in the
+rumour that in the nineteenth century the trees were all pollards?"
+
+This was catching me on my archaeological natural-history side, and I
+fell into the trap without any thought of where and when I was; so I
+began on it, while one of the girls, the handsome one, who had been
+scattering little twigs of lavender and other sweet-smelling herbs
+about the floor, came near to listen, and stood behind me with her
+hand on my shoulder, in which she held some of the plant that I used
+to call balm: its strong sweet smell brought back to my mind my very
+early days in the kitchen-garden at Woodford, and the large blue
+plums which grew on the wall beyond the sweet-herb patch,--a
+connection of memories which all boys will see at once.
+
+I started off: "When I was a boy, and for long after, except for a
+piece about Queen Elizabeth's Lodge, and for the part about High
+Beech, the Forest was almost wholly made up of pollard hornbeams
+mixed with holly thickets. But when the Corporation of London took
+it over about twenty-five years ago, the topping and lopping, which
+was a part of the old commoners' rights, came to an end, and the
+trees were let to grow. But I have not seen the place now for many
+years, except once, when we Leaguers went a pleasuring to High Beech.
+I was very much shocked then to see how it was built-over and
+altered; and the other day we heard that the philistines were going
+to landscape-garden it. But what you were saying about the building
+being stopped and the trees growing is only too good news;--only you
+know--"
+
+At that point I suddenly remembered Dick's date, and stopped short
+rather confused. The eager weaver didn't notice my confusion, but
+said hastily, as if he were almost aware of his breach of good
+manners, "But, I say, how old are you?"
+
+Dick and the pretty girl both burst out laughing, as if Robert's
+conduct were excusable on the grounds of eccentricity; and Dick said
+amidst his laughter:
+
+"Hold hard, Bob; this questioning of guests won't do. Why, much
+learning is spoiling you. You remind me of the radical cobblers in
+the silly old novels, who, according to the authors, were prepared to
+trample down all good manners in the pursuit of utilitarian
+knowledge. The fact is, I begin to think that you have so muddled
+your head with mathematics, and with grubbing into those idiotic old
+books about political economy (he he!), that you scarcely know how to
+behave. Really, it is about time for you to take to some open-air
+work, so that you may clear away the cobwebs from your brain."
+
+The weaver only laughed good-humouredly; and the girl went up to him
+and patted his cheek and said laughingly, "Poor fellow! he was born
+so."
+
+As for me, I was a little puzzled, but I laughed also, partly for
+company's sake, and partly with pleasure at their unanxious happiness
+and good temper; and before Robert could make the excuse to me which
+he was getting ready, I said:
+
+"But neighbours" (I had caught up that word), "I don't in the least
+mind answering questions, when I can do so: ask me as many as you
+please; it's fun for me. I will tell you all about Epping Forest
+when I was a boy, if you please; and as to my age, I'm not a fine
+lady, you know, so why shouldn't I tell you? I'm hard on fifty-six."
+
+In spite of the recent lecture on good manners, the weaver could not
+help giving a long "whew" of astonishment, and the others were so
+amused by his naivete that the merriment flitted all over their
+faces, though for courtesy's sake they forbore actual laughter; while
+I looked from one to the other in a puzzled manner, and at last said:
+
+"Tell me, please, what is amiss: you know I want to learn from you.
+And please laugh; only tell me."
+
+Well, they DID laugh, and I joined them again, for the above-stated
+reasons. But at last the pretty woman said coaxingly -
+
+"Well, well, he IS rude, poor fellow! but you see I may as well tell
+you what he is thinking about: he means that you look rather old for
+your age. But surely there need be no wonder in that, since you have
+been travelling; and clearly from all you have been saying, in
+unsocial countries. It has often been said, and no doubt truly, that
+one ages very quickly if one lives amongst unhappy people. Also they
+say that southern England is a good place for keeping good looks."
+She blushed and said: "How old am I, do you think?"
+
+"Well," quoth I, "I have always been told that a woman is as old as
+she looks, so without offence or flattery, I should say that you were
+twenty."
+
+She laughed merrily, and said, "I am well served out for fishing for
+compliments, since I have to tell you the truth, to wit, that I am
+forty-two."
+
+I stared at her, and drew musical laughter from her again; but I
+might well stare, for there was not a careful line on her face; her
+skin was as smooth as ivory, her cheeks full and round, her lips as
+red as the roses she had brought in; her beautiful arms, which she
+had bared for her work, firm and well-knit from shoulder to wrist.
+She blushed a little under my gaze, though it was clear that she had
+taken me for a man of eighty; so to pass it off I said -
+
+"Well, you see, the old saw is proved right again, and I ought not to
+have let you tempt me into asking you a rude question."
+
+She laughed again, and said: "Well, lads, old and young, I must get
+to my work now. We shall be rather busy here presently; and I want
+to clear it off soon, for I began to read a pretty old book
+yesterday, and I want to get on with it this morning: so good-bye
+for the present."
+
+She waved a hand to us, and stepped lightly down the hall, taking (as
+Scott says) at least part of the sun from our table as she went.
+
+When she was gone, Dick said "Now guest, won't you ask a question or
+two of our friend here? It is only fair that you should have your
+turn."
+
+"I shall be very glad to answer them," said the weaver.
+
+"If I ask you any questions, sir," said I, "they will not be very
+severe; but since I hear that you are a weaver, I should like to ask
+you something about that craft, as I am--or was--interested in it."
+
+"Oh," said he, "I shall not be of much use to you there, I'm afraid.
+I only do the most mechanical kind of weaving, and am in fact but a
+poor craftsman, unlike Dick here. Then besides the weaving, I do a
+little with machine printing and composing, though I am little use at
+the finer kinds of printing; and moreover machine printing is
+beginning to die out, along with the waning of the plague of book-
+making, so I have had to turn to other things that I have a taste
+for, and have taken to mathematics; and also I am writing a sort of
+antiquarian book about the peaceable and private history, so to say,
+of the end of the nineteenth century,--more for the sake of giving a
+picture of the country before the fighting began than for anything
+else. That was why I asked you those questions about Epping Forest.
+You have rather puzzled me, I confess, though your information was so
+interesting. But later on, I hope, we may have some more talk
+together, when our friend Dick isn't here. I know he thinks me
+rather a grinder, and despises me for not being very deft with my
+hands: that's the way nowadays. From what I have read of the
+nineteenth century literature (and I have read a good deal), it is
+clear to me that this is a kind of revenge for the stupidity of that
+day, which despised everybody who COULD use his hands. But Dick, old
+fellow, Ne quid nimis! Don't overdo it!"
+
+"Come now," said Dick, "am I likely to? Am I not the most tolerant
+man in the world? Am I not quite contented so long as you don't make
+me learn mathematics, or go into your new science of aesthetics, and
+let me do a little practical aesthetics with my gold and steel, and
+the blowpipe and the nice little hammer? But, hillo! here comes
+another questioner for you, my poor guest. I say, Bob, you must help
+me to defend him now."
+
+"Here, Boffin," he cried out, after a pause; "here we are, if you
+must have it!"
+
+I looked over my shoulder, and saw something flash and gleam in the
+sunlight that lay across the hall; so I turned round, and at my ease
+saw a splendid figure slowly sauntering over the pavement; a man
+whose surcoat was embroidered most copiously as well as elegantly, so
+that the sun flashed back from him as if he had been clad in golden
+armour. The man himself was tall, dark-haired, and exceedingly
+handsome, and though his face was no less kindly in expression than
+that of the others, he moved with that somewhat haughty mien which
+great beauty is apt to give to both men and women. He came and sat
+down at our table with a smiling face, stretching out his long legs
+and hanging his arm over the chair in the slowly graceful way which
+tall and well-built people may use without affectation. He was a man
+in the prime of life, but looked as happy as a child who has just got
+a new toy. He bowed gracefully to me and said -
+
+"I see clearly that you are the guest, of whom Annie has just told
+me, who have come from some distant country that does not know of us,
+or our ways of life. So I daresay you would not mind answering me a
+few questions; for you see--"
+
+Here Dick broke in: "No, please, Boffin! let it alone for the
+present. Of course you want the guest to be happy and comfortable;
+and how can that be if he has to trouble himself with answering all
+sorts of questions while he is still confused with the new customs
+and people about him? No, no: I am going to take him where he can
+ask questions himself, and have them answered; that is, to my great-
+grandfather in Bloomsbury: and I am sure you can't have anything to
+say against that. So instead of bothering, you had much better go
+out to James Allen's and get a carriage for me, as I shall drive him
+up myself; and please tell Jim to let me have the old grey, for I can
+drive a wherry much better than a carriage. Jump up, old fellow, and
+don't be disappointed; our guest will keep himself for you and your
+stories."
+
+I stared at Dick; for I wondered at his speaking to such a dignified-
+looking personage so familiarly, not to say curtly; for I thought
+that this Mr. Boffin, in spite of his well-known name out of Dickens,
+must be at the least a senator of these strange people. However, he
+got up and said, "All right, old oar-wearer, whatever you like; this
+is not one of my busy days; and though" (with a condescending bow to
+me) "my pleasure of a talk with this learned guest is put off, I
+admit that he ought to see your worthy kinsman as soon as possible.
+Besides, perhaps he will be the better able to answer MY questions
+after his own have been answered."
+
+And therewith he turned and swung himself out of the hall.
+
+When he was well gone, I said: "Is it wrong to ask what Mr. Boffin
+is? whose name, by the way, reminds me of many pleasant hours passed
+in reading Dickens."
+
+Dick laughed. "Yes, yes," said he, "as it does us. I see you take
+the allusion. Of course his real name is not Boffin, but Henry
+Johnson; we only call him Boffin as a joke, partly because he is a
+dustman, and partly because he will dress so showily, and get as much
+gold on him as a baron of the Middle Ages. As why should he not if
+he likes? only we are his special friends, you know, so of course we
+jest with him."
+
+I held my tongue for some time after that; but Dick went on:
+
+"He is a capital fellow, and you can't help liking him; but he has a
+weakness: he will spend his time in writing reactionary novels, and
+is very proud of getting the local colour right, as he calls it; and
+as he thinks you come from some forgotten corner of the earth, where
+people are unhappy, and consequently interesting to a story-teller,
+he thinks he might get some information out of you. O, he will be
+quite straightforward with you, for that matter. Only for your own
+comfort beware of him!"
+
+"Well, Dick," said the weaver, doggedly, "I think his novels are very
+good."
+
+"Of course you do," said Dick; "birds of a feather flock together;
+mathematics and antiquarian novels stand on much the same footing.
+But here he comes again."
+
+And in effect the Golden Dustman hailed us from the hall-door; so we
+all got up and went into the porch, before which, with a strong grey
+horse in the shafts, stood a carriage ready for us which I could not
+help noticing. It was light and handy, but had none of that
+sickening vulgarity which I had known as inseparable from the
+carriages of our time, especially the "elegant" ones, but was as
+graceful and pleasant in line as a Wessex waggon. We got in, Dick
+and I. The girls, who had come into the porch to see us off, waved
+their hands to us; the weaver nodded kindly; the dustman bowed as
+gracefully as a troubadour; Dick shook the reins, and we were off.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV: A MARKET BY THE WAY
+
+
+
+We turned away from the river at once, and were soon in the main road
+that runs through Hammersmith. But I should have had no guess as to
+where I was, if I had not started from the waterside; for King Street
+was gone, and the highway ran through wide sunny meadows and garden-
+like tillage. The Creek, which we crossed at once, had been rescued
+from its culvert, and as we went over its pretty bridge we saw its
+waters, yet swollen by the tide, covered with gay boats of different
+sizes. There were houses about, some on the road, some amongst the
+fields with pleasant lanes leading down to them, and each surrounded
+by a teeming garden. They were all pretty in design, and as solid as
+might be, but countryfied in appearance, like yeomen's dwellings;
+some of them of red brick like those by the river, but more of timber
+and plaster, which were by the necessity of their construction so
+like mediaeval houses of the same materials that I fairly felt as if
+I were alive in the fourteenth century; a sensation helped out by the
+costume of the people that we met or passed, in whose dress there was
+nothing "modern." Almost everybody was gaily dressed, but especially
+the women, who were so well-looking, or even so handsome, that I
+could scarcely refrain my tongue from calling my companion's
+attention to the fact. Some faces I saw that were thoughtful, and in
+these I noticed great nobility of expression, but none that had a
+glimmer of unhappiness, and the greater part (we came upon a good
+many people) were frankly and openly joyous.
+
+I thought I knew the Broadway by the lie of the roads that still met
+there. On the north side of the road was a range of buildings and
+courts, low, but very handsomely built and ornamented, and in that
+way forming a great contrast to the unpretentiousness of the houses
+round about; while above this lower building rose the steep lead-
+covered roof and the buttresses and higher part of the wall of a
+great hall, of a splendid and exuberant style of architecture, of
+which one can say little more than that it seemed to me to embrace
+the best qualities of the Gothic of northern Europe with those of the
+Saracenic and Byzantine, though there was no copying of any one of
+these styles. On the other, the south side, of the road was an
+octagonal building with a high roof, not unlike the Baptistry at
+Florence in outline, except that it was surrounded by a lean-to that
+clearly made an arcade or cloisters to it: it also was most
+delicately ornamented.
+
+This whole mass of architecture which we had come upon so suddenly
+from amidst the pleasant fields was not only exquisitely beautiful in
+itself, but it bore upon it the expression of such generosity and
+abundance of life that I was exhilarated to a pitch that I had never
+yet reached. I fairly chuckled for pleasure. My friend seemed to
+understand it, and sat looking on me with a pleased and affectionate
+interest. We had pulled up amongst a crowd of carts, wherein sat
+handsome healthy-looking people, men, women, and children very gaily
+dressed, and which were clearly market carts, as they were full of
+very tempting-looking country produce.
+
+I said, "I need not ask if this is a market, for I see clearly that
+it is; but what market is it that it is so splendid? And what is the
+glorious hall there, and what is the building on the south side?"
+
+"O," said he, "it is just our Hammersmith market; and I am glad you
+like it so much, for we are really proud of it. Of course the hall
+inside is our winter Mote-House; for in summer we mostly meet in the
+fields down by the river opposite Barn Elms. The building on our
+right hand is our theatre: I hope you like it."
+
+"I should be a fool if I didn't," said I.
+
+He blushed a little as he said: "I am glad of that, too, because I
+had a hand in it; I made the great doors, which are of damascened
+bronze. We will look at them later in the day, perhaps: but we
+ought to be getting on now. As to the market, this is not one of our
+busy days; so we shall do better with it another time, because you
+will see more people."
+
+I thanked him, and said: "Are these the regular country people?
+What very pretty girls there are amongst them."
+
+As I spoke, my eye caught the face of a beautiful woman, tall, dark-
+haired, and white-skinned, dressed in a pretty light-green dress in
+honour of the season and the hot day, who smiled kindly on me, and
+more kindly still, I thought on Dick; so I stopped a minute, but
+presently went on:
+
+"I ask because I do not see any of the country-looking people I
+should have expected to see at a market--I mean selling things
+there."
+
+"I don't understand," said he, "what kind of people you would expect
+to see; nor quite what you mean by 'country' people. These are the
+neighbours, and that like they run in the Thames valley. There are
+parts of these islands which are rougher and rainier than we are
+here, and there people are rougher in their dress; and they
+themselves are tougher and more hard-bitten than we are to look at.
+But some people like their looks better than ours; they say they have
+more character in them--that's the word. Well, it's a matter of
+taste.--Anyhow, the cross between us and them generally turns out
+well," added he, thoughtfully.
+
+I heard him, though my eyes were turned away from him, for that
+pretty girl was just disappearing through the gate with her big
+basket of early peas, and I felt that disappointed kind of feeling
+which overtakes one when one has seen an interesting or lovely face
+in the streets which one is never likely to see again; and I was
+silent a little. At last I said: "What I mean is, that I haven't
+seen any poor people about--not one."
+
+He knit his brows, looked puzzled, and said: "No, naturally; if
+anybody is poorly, he is likely to be within doors, or at best
+crawling about the garden: but I don't know of any one sick at
+present. Why should you expect to see poorly people on the road?"
+
+"No, no," I said; "I don't mean sick people. I mean poor people, you
+know; rough people."
+
+"No," said he, smiling merrily, "I really do not know. The fact is,
+you must come along quick to my great-grandfather, who will
+understand you better than I do. Come on, Greylocks!" Therewith he
+shook the reins, and we jogged along merrily eastward.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V: CHILDREN ON THE ROAD
+
+
+
+Past the Broadway there were fewer houses on either side. We
+presently crossed a pretty little brook that ran across a piece of
+land dotted over with trees, and awhile after came to another market
+and town-hall, as we should call it. Although there was nothing
+familiar to me in its surroundings, I knew pretty well where we were,
+and was not surprised when my guide said briefly, "Kensington
+Market."
+
+Just after this we came into a short street of houses: or rather,
+one long house on either side of the way, built of timber and
+plaster, and with a pretty arcade over the footway before it.
+
+Quoth Dick: "This is Kensington proper. People are apt to gather
+here rather thick, for they like the romance of the wood; and
+naturalists haunt it, too; for it is a wild spot even here, what
+there is of it; for it does not go far to the south: it goes from
+here northward and west right over Paddington and a little way down
+Notting Hill: thence it runs north-east to Primrose Hill, and so on;
+rather a narrow strip of it gets through Kingsland to Stoke-Newington
+and Clapton, where it spreads out along the heights above the Lea
+marshes; on the other side of which, as you know, is Epping Forest
+holding out a hand to it. This part we are just coming to is called
+Kensington Gardens; though why 'gardens' I don't know."
+
+I rather longed to say, "Well, _I_ know"; but there were so many
+things about me which I did NOT know, in spite of his assumptions,
+that I thought it better to hold my tongue.
+
+The road plunged at once into a beautiful wood spreading out on
+either side, but obviously much further on the north side, where even
+the oaks and sweet chestnuts were of a good growth; while the
+quicker-growing trees (amongst which I thought the planes and
+sycamores too numerous) were very big and fine-grown.
+
+It was exceedingly pleasant in the dappled shadow, for the day was
+growing as hot as need be, and the coolness and shade soothed my
+excited mind into a condition of dreamy pleasure, so that I felt as
+if I should like to go on for ever through that balmy freshness. My
+companion seemed to share in my feelings, and let the horse go slower
+and slower as he sat inhaling the green forest scents, chief amongst
+which was the smell of the trodden bracken near the wayside.
+
+Romantic as this Kensington wood was, however, it was not lonely. We
+came on many groups both coming and going, or wandering in the edges
+of the wood. Amongst these were many children from six or eight
+years old up to sixteen or seventeen. They seemed to me to be
+especially fine specimens of their race, and enjoying themselves to
+the utmost; some of them were hanging about little tents pitched on
+the greensward, and by some of these fires were burning, with pots
+hanging over them gipsy fashion. Dick explained to me that there
+were scattered houses in the forest, and indeed we caught a glimpse
+of one or two. He said they were mostly quite small, such as used to
+be called cottages when there were slaves in the land, but they were
+pleasant enough and fitting for the wood.
+
+"They must be pretty well stocked with children," said I, pointing to
+the many youngsters about the way.
+
+"O," said he, "these children do not all come from the near houses,
+the woodland houses, but from the country-side generally. They often
+make up parties, and come to play in the woods for weeks together in
+summer-time, living in tents, as you see. We rather encourage them
+to it; they learn to do things for themselves, and get to notice the
+wild creatures; and, you see, the less they stew inside houses the
+better for them. Indeed, I must tell you that many grown people will
+go to live in the forests through the summer; though they for the
+most part go to the bigger ones, like Windsor, or the Forest of Dean,
+or the northern wastes. Apart from the other pleasures of it, it
+gives them a little rough work, which I am sorry to say is getting
+somewhat scarce for these last fifty years."
+
+He broke off, and then said, "I tell you all this, because I see that
+if I talk I must be answering questions, which you are thinking, even
+if you are not speaking them out; but my kinsman will tell you more
+about it."
+
+I saw that I was likely to get out of my depth again, and so merely
+for the sake of tiding over an awkwardness and to say something, I
+said -
+
+"Well, the youngsters here will be all the fresher for school when
+the summer gets over and they have to go back again."
+
+"School?" he said; "yes, what do you mean by that word? I don't see
+how it can have anything to do with children. We talk, indeed, of a
+school of herring, and a school of painting, and in the former sense
+we might talk of a school of children--but otherwise," said he,
+laughing, "I must own myself beaten."
+
+Hang it! thought I, I can't open my mouth without digging up some new
+complexity. I wouldn't try to set my friend right in his etymology;
+and I thought I had best say nothing about the boy-farms which I had
+been used to call schools, as I saw pretty clearly that they had
+disappeared; so I said after a little fumbling, "I was using the word
+in the sense of a system of education."
+
+"Education?" said he, meditatively, "I know enough Latin to know that
+the word must come from educere, to lead out; and I have heard it
+used; but I have never met anybody who could give me a clear
+explanation of what it means."
+
+You may imagine how my new friends fell in my esteem when I heard
+this frank avowal; and I said, rather contemptuously, "Well,
+education means a system of teaching young people."
+
+"Why not old people also?" said he with a twinkle in his eye. "But,"
+he went on, "I can assure you our children learn, whether they go
+through a 'system of teaching' or not. Why, you will not find one of
+these children about here, boy or girl, who cannot swim; and every
+one of them has been used to tumbling about the little forest ponies-
+-there's one of them now! They all of them know how to cook; the
+bigger lads can mow; many can thatch and do odd jobs at carpentering;
+or they know how to keep shop. I can tell you they know plenty of
+things."
+
+"Yes, but their mental education, the teaching of their minds," said
+I, kindly translating my phrase.
+
+"Guest," said he, "perhaps you have not learned to do these things I
+have been speaking about; and if that's the case, don't you run away
+with the idea that it doesn't take some skill to do them, and doesn't
+give plenty of work for one's mind: you would change your opinion if
+you saw a Dorsetshire lad thatching, for instance. But, however, I
+understand you to be speaking of book-learning; and as to that, it is
+a simple affair. Most children, seeing books lying about, manage to
+read by the time they are four years old; though I am told it has not
+always been so. As to writing, we do not encourage them to scrawl
+too early (though scrawl a little they will), because it gets them
+into a habit of ugly writing; and what's the use of a lot of ugly
+writing being done, when rough printing can be done so easily. You
+understand that handsome writing we like, and many people will write
+their books out when they make them, or get them written; I mean
+books of which only a few copies are needed--poems, and such like,
+you know. However, I am wandering from my lambs; but you must excuse
+me, for I am interested in this matter of writing, being myself a
+fair-writer."
+
+"Well," said I, "about the children; when they know how to read and
+write, don't they learn something else--languages, for instance?"
+
+"Of course," he said; "sometimes even before they can read, they can
+talk French, which is the nearest language talked on the other side
+of the water; and they soon get to know German also, which is talked
+by a huge number of communes and colleges on the mainland. These are
+the principal languages we speak in these islands, along with English
+or Welsh, or Irish, which is another form of Welsh; and children pick
+them up very quickly, because their elders all know them; and besides
+our guests from over sea often bring their children with them, and
+the little ones get together, and rub their speech into one another."
+
+"And the older languages?" said I.
+
+"O, yes," said he, "they mostly learn Latin and Greek along with the
+modern ones, when they do anything more than merely pick up the
+latter."
+
+"And history?" said I; "how do you teach history?"
+
+"Well," said he, "when a person can read, of course he reads what he
+likes to; and he can easily get someone to tell him what are the best
+books to read on such or such a subject, or to explain what he
+doesn't understand in the books when he is reading them."
+
+"Well," said I, "what else do they learn? I suppose they don't all
+learn history?"
+
+"No, no," said he; "some don't care about it; in fact, I don't think
+many do. I have heard my great-grandfather say that it is mostly in
+periods of turmoil and strife and confusion that people care much
+about history; and you know," said my friend, with an amiable smile,
+"we are not like that now. No; many people study facts about the
+make of things and the matters of cause and effect, so that knowledge
+increases on us, if that be good; and some, as you heard about friend
+Bob yonder, will spend time over mathematics. 'Tis no use forcing
+people's tastes."
+
+Said I: "But you don't mean that children learn all these things?"
+
+Said he: "That depends on what you mean by children; and also you
+must remember how much they differ. As a rule, they don't do much
+reading, except for a few story-books, till they are about fifteen
+years old; we don't encourage early bookishness: though you will
+find some children who WILL take to books very early; which perhaps
+is not good for them; but it's no use thwarting them; and very often
+it doesn't last long with them, and they find their level before they
+are twenty years old. You see, children are mostly given to
+imitating their elders, and when they see most people about them
+engaged in genuinely amusing work, like house-building and street-
+paving, and gardening, and the like, that is what they want to be
+doing; so I don't think we need fear having too many book-learned
+men."
+
+What could I say? I sat and held my peace, for fear of fresh
+entanglements. Besides, I was using my eyes with all my might,
+wondering as the old horse jogged on, when I should come into London
+proper, and what it would be like now.
+
+But my companion couldn't let his subject quite drop, and went on
+meditatively:
+
+"After all, I don't know that it does them much harm, even if they do
+grow up book-students. Such people as that, 'tis a great pleasure
+seeing them so happy over work which is not much sought for. And
+besides, these students are generally such pleasant people; so kind
+and sweet tempered; so humble, and at the same time so anxious to
+teach everybody all that they know. Really, I like those that I have
+met prodigiously."
+
+This seemed to me such very queer talk that I was on the point of
+asking him another question; when just as we came to the top of a
+rising ground, down a long glade of the wood on my right I caught
+sight of a stately building whose outline was familiar to me, and I
+cried out, "Westminster Abbey!"
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "Westminster Abbey--what there is left of it."
+
+"Why, what have you done with it?" quoth I in terror.
+
+"What have WE done with it?" said he; "nothing much, save clean it.
+But you know the whole outside was spoiled centuries ago: as to the
+inside, that remains in its beauty after the great clearance, which
+took place over a hundred years ago, of the beastly monuments to
+fools and knaves, which once blocked it up, as great-grandfather
+says."
+
+We went on a little further, and I looked to the right again, and
+said, in rather a doubtful tone of voice, "Why, there are the Houses
+of Parliament! Do you still use them?"
+
+He burst out laughing, and was some time before he could control
+himself; then he clapped me on the back and said:
+
+"I take you, neighbour; you may well wonder at our keeping them
+standing, and I know something about that, and my old kinsman has
+given me books to read about the strange game that they played there.
+Use them! Well, yes, they are used for a sort of subsidiary market,
+and a storage place for manure, and they are handy for that, being on
+the waterside. I believe it was intended to pull them down quite at
+the beginning of our days; but there was, I am told, a queer
+antiquarian society, which had done some service in past times, and
+which straightway set up its pipe against their destruction, as it
+has done with many other buildings, which most people looked upon as
+worthless, and public nuisances; and it was so energetic, and had
+such good reasons to give, that it generally gained its point; and I
+must say that when all is said I am glad of it: because you know at
+the worst these silly old buildings serve as a kind of foil to the
+beautiful ones which we build now. You will see several others in
+these parts; the place my great-grandfather lives in, for instance,
+and a big building called St. Paul's. And you see, in this matter we
+need not grudge a few poorish buildings standing, because we can
+always build elsewhere; nor need we be anxious as to the breeding of
+pleasant work in such matters, for there is always room for more and
+more work in a new building, even without making it pretentious. For
+instance, elbow-room WITHIN doors is to me so delightful that if I
+were driven to it I would most sacrifice outdoor space to it. Then,
+of course, there is the ornament, which, as we must all allow, may
+easily be overdone in mere living houses, but can hardly be in mote-
+halls and markets, and so forth. I must tell you, though, that my
+great-grandfather sometimes tells me I am a little cracked on this
+subject of fine building; and indeed I DO think that the energies of
+mankind are chiefly of use to them for such work; for in that
+direction I can see no end to the work, while in many others a limit
+does seem possible."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI: A LITTLE SHOPPING
+
+
+
+As he spoke, we came suddenly out of the woodland into a short street
+of handsomely built houses, which my companion named to me at once as
+Piccadilly: the lower part of these I should have called shops, if
+it had not been that, as far as I could see, the people were ignorant
+of the arts of buying and selling. Wares were displayed in their
+finely designed fronts, as if to tempt people in, and people stood
+and looked at them, or went in and came out with parcels under their
+arms, just like the real thing. On each side of the street ran an
+elegant arcade to protect foot-passengers, as in some of the old
+Italian cities. About halfway down, a huge building of the kind I
+was now prepared to expect told me that this also was a centre of
+some kind, and had its special public buildings.
+
+Said Dick: "Here, you see, is another market on a different plan
+from most others: the upper stories of these houses are used for
+guest-houses; for people from all about the country are apt to drift
+up hither from time to time, as folk are very thick upon the ground,
+which you will see evidence of presently, and there are people who
+are fond of crowds, though I can't say that I am."
+
+I couldn't help smiling to see how long a tradition would last. Here
+was the ghost of London still asserting itself as a centre,--an
+intellectual centre, for aught I knew. However, I said nothing,
+except that I asked him to drive very slowly, as the things in the
+booths looked exceedingly pretty.
+
+"Yes," said he, "this is a very good market for pretty things, and is
+mostly kept for the handsomer goods, as the Houses-of-Parliament
+market, where they set out cabbages and turnips and such like things,
+along with beer and the rougher kind of wine, is so near."
+
+Then he looked at me curiously, and said, "Perhaps you would like to
+do a little shopping, as 'tis called."
+
+I looked at what I could see of my rough blue duds, which I had
+plenty of opportunity of contrasting with the gay attire of the
+citizens we had come across; and I thought that if, as seemed likely,
+I should presently be shown about as a curiosity for the amusement of
+this most unbusinesslike people, I should like to look a little less
+like a discharged ship's purser. But in spite of all that had
+happened, my hand went down into my pocket again, where to my dismay
+it met nothing metallic except two rusty old keys, and I remembered
+that amidst our talk in the guest-hall at Hammersmith I had taken the
+cash out of my pocket to show to the pretty Annie, and had left it
+lying there. My face fell fifty per cent., and Dick, beholding me,
+said rather sharply -
+
+"Hilloa, Guest! what's the matter now? Is it a wasp?"
+
+"No," said I, "but I've left it behind."
+
+"Well," said he, "whatever you have left behind, you can get in this
+market again, so don't trouble yourself about it."
+
+I had come to my senses by this time, and remembering the astounding
+customs of this country, had no mind for another lecture on social
+economy and the Edwardian coinage; so I said only -
+
+"My clothes--Couldn't I? You see--What do think could be done about
+them?"
+
+He didn't seem in the least inclined to laugh, but said quite
+gravely:
+
+"O don't get new clothes yet. You see, my great-grandfather is an
+antiquarian, and he will want to see you just as you are. And, you
+know, I mustn't preach to you, but surely it wouldn't be right for
+you to take away people's pleasure of studying your attire, by just
+going and making yourself like everybody else. You feel that, don't
+you?" said he, earnestly.
+
+I did NOT feel it my duty to set myself up for a scarecrow amidst
+this beauty-loving people, but I saw I had got across some
+ineradicable prejudice, and that it wouldn't do to quarrel with my
+new friend. So I merely said, "O certainly, certainly."
+
+"Well," said he, pleasantly, "you may as well see what the inside of
+these booths is like: think of something you want."
+
+Said I: "Could I get some tobacco and a pipe?"
+
+"Of course," said he; "what was I thinking of, not asking you before?
+Well, Bob is always telling me that we non-smokers are a selfish lot,
+and I'm afraid he is right. But come along; here is a place just
+handy."
+
+Therewith he drew rein and jumped down, and I followed. A very
+handsome woman, splendidly clad in figured silk, was slowly passing
+by, looking into the windows as she went. To her quoth Dick:
+"Maiden, would you kindly hold our horse while we go in for a
+little?" She nodded to us with a kind smile, and fell to patting the
+horse with her pretty hand.
+
+"What a beautiful creature!" said I to Dick as we entered.
+
+"What, old Greylocks?" said he, with a sly grin.
+
+"No, no," said I; "Goldylocks,--the lady."
+
+"Well, so she is," said he. "'Tis a good job there are so many of
+them that every Jack may have his Jill: else I fear that we should
+get fighting for them. Indeed," said he, becoming very grave, "I
+don't say that it does not happen even now, sometimes. For you know
+love is not a very reasonable thing, and perversity and self-will are
+commoner than some of our moralist's think." He added, in a still
+more sombre tone: "Yes, only a month ago there was a mishap down by
+us, that in the end cost the lives of two men and a woman, and, as it
+were, put out the sunlight for us for a while. Don't ask me about it
+just now; I may tell you about it later on."
+
+By this time we were within the shop or booth, which had a counter,
+and shelves on the walls, all very neat, though without any pretence
+of showiness, but otherwise not very different to what I had been
+used to. Within were a couple of children--a brown-skinned boy of
+about twelve, who sat reading a book, and a pretty little girl of
+about a year older, who was sitting also reading behind the counter;
+they were obviously brother and sister.
+
+"Good morning, little neighbours," said Dick. "My friend here wants
+tobacco and a pipe; can you help him?"
+
+"O yes, certainly," said the girl with a sort of demure alertness
+which was somewhat amusing. The boy looked up, and fell to staring
+at my outlandish attire, but presently reddened and turned his head,
+as if he knew that he was not behaving prettily.
+
+"Dear neighbour," said the girl, with the most solemn countenance of
+a child playing at keeping shop, "what tobacco is it you would like?"
+
+"Latakia," quoth I, feeling as if I were assisting at a child's game,
+and wondering whether I should get anything but make-believe.
+
+But the girl took a dainty little basket from a shelf beside her,
+went to a jar, and took out a lot of tobacco and put the filled
+basket down on the counter before me, where I could both smell and
+see that it was excellent Latakia.
+
+"But you haven't weighed it," said I, "and--and how much am I to
+take?"
+
+"Why," she said, "I advise you to cram your bag, because you may be
+going where you can't get Latakia. Where is your bag?"
+
+I fumbled about, and at last pulled out my piece of cotton print
+which does duty with me for a tobacco pouch. But the girl looked at
+it with some disdain, and said -
+
+"Dear neighbour, I can give you something much better than that
+cotton rag." And she tripped up the shop and came back presently,
+and as she passed the boy whispered something in his ear, and he
+nodded and got up and went out. The girl held up in her finger and
+thumb a red morocco bag, gaily embroidered, and said, "There, I have
+chosen one for you, and you are to have it: it is pretty, and will
+hold a lot."
+
+Therewith she fell to cramming it with the tobacco, and laid it down
+by me and said, "Now for the pipe: that also you must let me choose
+for you; there are three pretty ones just come in."
+
+She disappeared again, and came back with a big-bowled pipe in her
+hand, carved out of some hard wood very elaborately, and mounted in
+gold sprinkled with little gems. It was, in short, as pretty and gay
+a toy as I had ever seen; something like the best kind of Japanese
+work, but better.
+
+"Dear me!" said I, when I set eyes on it, "this is altogether too
+grand for me, or for anybody but the Emperor of the World. Besides,
+I shall lose it: I always lose my pipes."
+
+The child seemed rather dashed, and said, "Don't you like it,
+neighbour?"
+
+"O yes," I said, "of course I like it."
+
+"Well, then, take it," said she, "and don't trouble about losing it.
+What will it matter if you do? Somebody is sure to find it, and he
+will use it, and you can get another."
+
+I took it out of her hand to look at it, and while I did so, forgot
+my caution, and said, "But however am I to pay for such a thing as
+this?"
+
+Dick laid his hand on my shoulder as I spoke, and turning I met his
+eyes with a comical expression in them, which warned me against
+another exhibition of extinct commercial morality; so I reddened and
+held my tongue, while the girl simply looked at me with the deepest
+gravity, as if I were a foreigner blundering in my speech, for she
+clearly didn't understand me a bit.
+
+"Thank you so very much," I said at last, effusively, as I put the
+pipe in my pocket, not without a qualm of doubt as to whether I
+shouldn't find myself before a magistrate presently.
+
+"O, you are so very welcome," said the little lass, with an
+affectation of grown-up manners at their best which was very quaint.
+"It is such a pleasure to serve dear old gentlemen like you;
+especially when one can see at once that you have come from far over
+sea."
+
+"Yes, my dear," quoth I, "I have been a great traveller."
+
+As I told this lie from pure politeness, in came the lad again, with
+a tray in his hands, on which I saw a long flask and two beautiful
+glasses. "Neighbours," said the girl (who did all the talking, her
+brother being very shy, clearly) "please to drink a glass to us
+before you go, since we do not have guests like this every day."
+
+Therewith the boy put the tray on the counter and solemnly poured out
+a straw-coloured wine into the long bowls. Nothing loth, I drank,
+for I was thirsty with the hot day; and thinks I, I am yet in the
+world, and the grapes of the Rhine have not yet lost their flavour;
+for if ever I drank good Steinberg, I drank it that morning; and I
+made a mental note to ask Dick how they managed to make fine wine
+when there were no longer labourers compelled to drink rot-gut
+instead of the fine wine which they themselves made.
+
+"Don't you drink a glass to us, dear little neighbours?" said I.
+
+"I don't drink wine," said the lass; "I like lemonade better: but I
+wish your health!"
+
+"And I like ginger-beer better," said the little lad.
+
+Well, well, thought I, neither have children's tastes changed much.
+And therewith we gave them good day and went out of the booth.
+
+To my disappointment, like a change in a dream, a tall old man was
+holding our horse instead of the beautiful woman. He explained to us
+that the maiden could not wait, and that he had taken her place; and
+he winked at us and laughed when he saw how our faces fell, so that
+we had nothing for it but to laugh also -
+
+"Where are you going?" said he to Dick.
+
+"To Bloomsbury," said Dick.
+
+"If you two don't want to be alone, I'll come with you," said the old
+man.
+
+"All right," said Dick, "tell me when you want to get down and I'll
+stop for you. Let's get on."
+
+So we got under way again; and I asked if children generally waited
+on people in the markets. "Often enough," said he, "when it isn't a
+matter of dealing with heavy weights, but by no means always. The
+children like to amuse themselves with it, and it is good for them,
+because they handle a lot of diverse wares and get to learn about
+them, how they are made, and where they come from, and so on.
+Besides, it is such very easy work that anybody can do it. It is
+said that in the early days of our epoch there were a good many
+people who were hereditarily afflicted with a disease called
+Idleness, because they were the direct descendants of those who in
+the bad times used to force other people to work for them--the
+people, you know, who are called slave-holders or employers of labour
+in the history books. Well, these Idleness-stricken people used to
+serve booths ALL their time, because they were fit for so little.
+Indeed, I believe that at one time they were actually COMPELLED to do
+some such work, because they, especially the women, got so ugly and
+produced such ugly children if their disease was not treated sharply,
+that the neighbours couldn't stand it. However, I'm happy to say
+that all that is gone by now; the disease is either extinct, or
+exists in such a mild form that a short course of aperient medicine
+carries it off. It is sometimes called the Blue-devils now, or the
+Mulleygrubs. Queer names, ain't they?"
+
+"Yes," said I, pondering much. But the old man broke in:
+
+"Yes, all that is true, neighbour; and I have seen some of those poor
+women grown old. But my father used to know some of them when they
+were young; and he said that they were as little like young women as
+might be: they had hands like bunches of skewers, and wretched
+little arms like sticks; and waists like hour-glasses, and thin lips
+and peaked noses and pale cheeks; and they were always pretending to
+be offended at anything you said or did to them. No wonder they bore
+ugly children, for no one except men like them could be in love with
+them--poor things!"
+
+He stopped, and seemed to be musing on his past life, and then said:
+
+"And do you know, neighbours, that once on a time people were still
+anxious about that disease of Idleness: at one time we gave
+ourselves a great deal of trouble in trying to cure people of it.
+Have you not read any of the medical books on the subject?"
+
+"No," said I; for the old man was speaking to me.
+
+"Well," said he, "it was thought at the time that it was the survival
+of the old mediaeval disease of leprosy: it seems it was very
+catching, for many of the people afflicted by it were much secluded,
+and were waited upon by a special class of diseased persons queerly
+dressed up, so that they might be known. They wore amongst other
+garments, breeches made of worsted velvet, that stuff which used to
+be called plush some years ago."
+
+All this seemed very interesting to me, and I should like to have
+made the old man talk more. But Dick got rather restive under so
+much ancient history: besides, I suspect he wanted to keep me as
+fresh as he could for his great-grandfather. So he burst out
+laughing at last, and said: "Excuse me, neighbours, but I can't help
+it. Fancy people not liking to work!--it's too ridiculous. Why,
+even you like to work, old fellow--sometimes," said he,
+affectionately patting the old horse with the whip. "What a queer
+disease! it may well be called Mulleygrubs!"
+
+And he laughed out again most boisterously; rather too much so, I
+thought, for his usual good manners; and I laughed with him for
+company's sake, but from the teeth outward only; for _I_ saw nothing
+funny in people not liking to work, as you may well imagine.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII: TRAFALGAR SQUARE
+
+
+
+And now again I was busy looking about me, for we were quite clear of
+Piccadilly Market, and were in a region of elegantly-built much
+ornamented houses, which I should have called villas if they had been
+ugly and pretentious, which was very far from being the case. Each
+house stood in a garden carefully cultivated, and running over with
+flowers. The blackbirds were singing their best amidst the garden-
+trees, which, except for a bay here and there, and occasional groups
+of limes, seemed to be all fruit-trees: there were a great many
+cherry-trees, now all laden with fruit; and several times as we
+passed by a garden we were offered baskets of fine fruit by children
+and young girls. Amidst all these gardens and houses it was of
+course impossible to trace the sites of the old streets: but it
+seemed to me that the main roadways were the same as of old.
+
+We came presently into a large open space, sloping somewhat toward
+the south, the sunny site of which had been taken advantage of for
+planting an orchard, mainly, as I could see, of apricot-trees, in the
+midst of which was a pretty gay little structure of wood, painted and
+gilded, that looked like a refreshment-stall. From the southern side
+of the said orchard ran a long road, chequered over with the shadow
+of tall old pear trees, at the end of which showed the high tower of
+the Parliament House, or Dung Market.
+
+A strange sensation came over me; I shut my eyes to keep out the
+sight of the sun glittering on this fair abode of gardens, and for a
+moment there passed before them a phantasmagoria of another day. A
+great space surrounded by tall ugly houses, with an ugly church at
+the corner and a nondescript ugly cupolaed building at my back; the
+roadway thronged with a sweltering and excited crowd, dominated by
+omnibuses crowded with spectators. In the midst a paved be-
+fountained square, populated only by a few men dressed in blue, and a
+good many singularly ugly bronze images (one on the top of a tall
+column). The said square guarded up to the edge of the roadway by a
+four-fold line of big men clad in blue, and across the southern
+roadway the helmets of a band of horse-soldiers, dead white in the
+greyness of the chilly November afternoon--I opened my eyes to the
+sunlight again and looked round me, and cried out among the
+whispering trees and odorous blossoms, "Trafalgar Square!"
+
+"Yes," said Dick, who had drawn rein again, "so it is. I don't
+wonder at your finding the name ridiculous: but after all, it was
+nobody's business to alter it, since the name of a dead folly doesn't
+bite. Yet sometimes I think we might have given it a name which
+would have commemorated the great battle which was fought on the spot
+itself in 1952,--that was important enough, if the historians don't
+lie."
+
+"Which they generally do, or at least did," said the old man. "For
+instance, what can you make of this, neighbours? I have read a
+muddled account in a book--O a stupid book--called James' Social
+Democratic History, of a fight which took place here in or about the
+year 1887 (I am bad at dates). Some people, says this story, were
+going to hold a ward-mote here, or some such thing, and the
+Government of London, or the Council, or the Commission, or what not
+other barbarous half-hatched body of fools, fell upon these citizens
+(as they were then called) with the armed hand. That seems too
+ridiculous to be true; but according to this version of the story,
+nothing much came of it, which certainly IS too ridiculous to be
+true."
+
+"Well," quoth I, "but after all your Mr. James is right so far, and
+it IS true; except that there was no fighting, merely unarmed and
+peaceable people attacked by ruffians armed with bludgeons."
+
+"And they put up with that?" said Dick, with the first unpleasant
+expression I had seen on his good-tempered face.
+
+Said I, reddening: "We HAD to put up with it; we couldn't help it."
+
+The old man looked at me keenly, and said: "You seem to know a great
+deal about it, neighbour! And is it really true that nothing came of
+it?"
+
+"This came of it," said I, "that a good many people were sent to
+prison because of it."
+
+"What, of the bludgeoners?" said the old man. "Poor devils!"
+
+"No, no," said I, "of the bludgeoned."
+
+Said the old man rather severely: "Friend, I expect that you have
+been reading some rotten collection of lies, and have been taken in
+by it too easily."
+
+"I assure you," said I, "what I have been saying is true."
+
+"Well, well, I am sure you think so, neighbour," said the old man,
+"but I don't see why you should be so cocksure."
+
+As I couldn't explain why, I held my tongue. Meanwhile Dick, who had
+been sitting with knit brows, cogitating, spoke at last, and said
+gently and rather sadly:
+
+"How strange to think that there have been men like ourselves, and
+living in this beautiful and happy country, who I suppose had
+feelings and affections like ourselves, who could yet do such
+dreadful things."
+
+"Yes," said I, in a didactic tone; "yet after all, even those days
+were a great improvement on the days that had gone before them. Have
+you not read of the Mediaeval period, and the ferocity of its
+criminal laws; and how in those days men fairly seemed to have
+enjoyed tormenting their fellow men?--nay, for the matter of that,
+they made their God a tormentor and a jailer rather than anything
+else."
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "there are good books on that period also, some of
+which I have read. But as to the great improvement of the nineteenth
+century, I don't see it. After all, the Mediaeval folk acted after
+their conscience, as your remark about their God (which is true)
+shows, and they were ready to bear what they inflicted on others;
+whereas the nineteenth century ones were hypocrites, and pretended to
+be humane, and yet went on tormenting those whom they dared to treat
+so by shutting them up in prison, for no reason at all, except that
+they were what they themselves, the prison-masters, had forced them
+to be. O, it's horrible to think of!"
+
+"But perhaps," said I, "they did not know what the prisons were
+like."
+
+Dick seemed roused, and even angry. "More shame for them," said he,
+"when you and I know it all these years afterwards. Look you,
+neighbour, they couldn't fail to know what a disgrace a prison is to
+the Commonwealth at the best, and that their prisons were a good step
+on towards being at the worst."
+
+Quoth I: "But have you no prisons at all now?"
+
+As soon as the words were out of my mouth, I felt that I had made a
+mistake, for Dick flushed red and frowned, and the old man looked
+surprised and pained; and presently Dick said angrily, yet as if
+restraining himself somewhat -
+
+"Man alive! how can you ask such a question? Have I not told you
+that we know what a prison means by the undoubted evidence of really
+trustworthy books, helped out by our own imaginations? And haven't
+you specially called me to notice that the people about the roads and
+streets look happy? and how could they look happy if they knew that
+their neighbours were shut up in prison, while they bore such things
+quietly? And if there were people in prison, you couldn't hide it
+from folk, like you may an occasional man-slaying; because that isn't
+done of set purpose, with a lot of people backing up the slayer in
+cold blood, as this prison business is. Prisons, indeed! O no, no,
+no!"
+
+He stopped, and began to cool down, and said in a kind voice: "But
+forgive me! I needn't be so hot about it, since there are NOT any
+prisons: I'm afraid you will think the worse of me for losing my
+temper. Of course, you, coming from the outlands, cannot be expected
+to know about these things. And now I'm afraid I have made you feel
+uncomfortable."
+
+In a way he had; but he was so generous in his heat, that I liked him
+the better for it, and I said:
+
+"No, really 'tis all my fault for being so stupid. Let me change the
+subject, and ask you what the stately building is on our left just
+showing at the end of that grove of plane-trees?"
+
+"Ah," he said, "that is an old building built before the middle of
+the twentieth century, and as you see, in a queer fantastic style not
+over beautiful; but there are some fine things inside it, too, mostly
+pictures, some very old. It is called the National Gallery; I have
+sometimes puzzled as to what the name means: anyhow, nowadays
+wherever there is a place where pictures are kept as curiosities
+permanently it is called a National Gallery, perhaps after this one.
+Of course there are a good many of them up and down the country."
+
+I didn't try to enlighten him, feeling the task too heavy; but I
+pulled out my magnificent pipe and fell a-smoking, and the old horse
+jogged on again. As we went, I said:
+
+"This pipe is a very elaborate toy, and you seem so reasonable in
+this country, and your architecture is so good, that I rather wonder
+at your turning out such trivialities."
+
+It struck me as I spoke that this was rather ungrateful of me, after
+having received such a fine present; but Dick didn't seem to notice
+my bad manners, but said:
+
+"Well, I don't know; it is a pretty thing, and since nobody need make
+such things unless they like, I don't see why they shouldn't make
+them, if they like. Of course, if carvers were scarce they would all
+be busy on the architecture, as you call it, and then these 'toys' (a
+good word) would not be made; but since there are plenty of people
+who can carve--in fact, almost everybody, and as work is somewhat
+scarce, or we are afraid it may be, folk do not discourage this kind
+of petty work."
+
+He mused a little, and seemed somewhat perturbed; but presently his
+face cleared, and he said: "After all, you must admit that the pipe
+is a very pretty thing, with the little people under the trees all
+cut so clean and sweet;--too elaborate for a pipe, perhaps, but--
+well, it is very pretty."
+
+"Too valuable for its use, perhaps," said I.
+
+"What's that?" said he; "I don't understand."
+
+I was just going in a helpless way to try to make him understand,
+when we came by the gates of a big rambling building, in which work
+of some sort seemed going on. "What building is that?" said I,
+eagerly; for it was a pleasure amidst all these strange things to see
+something a little like what I was used to: "it seems to be a
+factory."
+
+"Yes," he said, "I think I know what you mean, and that's what it is;
+but we don't call them factories now, but Banded-workshops: that is,
+places where people collect who want to work together."
+
+"I suppose," said I, "power of some sort is used there?"
+
+"No, no," said he. "Why should people collect together to use power,
+when they can have it at the places where they live, or hard by, any
+two or three of them; or any one, for the matter of that? No; folk
+collect in these Banded-workshops to do hand-work in which working
+together is necessary or convenient; such work is often very
+pleasant. In there, for instance, they make pottery and glass,--
+there, you can see the tops of the furnaces. Well, of course it's
+handy to have fair-sized ovens and kilns and glass-pots, and a good
+lot of things to use them for: though of course there are a good
+many such places, as it would be ridiculous if a man had a liking for
+pot-making or glass-blowing that he should have to live in one place
+or be obliged to forego the work he liked."
+
+"I see no smoke coming from the furnaces," said I.
+
+"Smoke?" said Dick; "why should you see smoke?"
+
+I held my tongue, and he went on: "It's a nice place inside, though
+as plain as you see outside. As to the crafts, throwing the clay
+must be jolly work: the glass-blowing is rather a sweltering job;
+but some folk like it very much indeed; and I don't much wonder:
+there is such a sense of power, when you have got deft in it, in
+dealing with the hot metal. It makes a lot of pleasant work," said
+he, smiling, "for however much care you take of such goods, break
+they will, one day or another, so there is always plenty to do."
+
+I held my tongue and pondered.
+
+We came just here on a gang of men road-mending which delayed us a
+little; but I was not sorry for it; for all I had seen hitherto
+seemed a mere part of a summer holiday; and I wanted to see how this
+folk would set to on a piece of real necessary work. They had been
+resting, and had only just begun work again as we came up; so that
+the rattle of the picks was what woke me from my musing. There were
+about a dozen of them, strong young men, looking much like a boating
+party at Oxford would have looked in the days I remembered, and not
+more troubled with their work: their outer raiment lay on the road-
+side in an orderly pile under the guardianship of a six-year-old boy,
+who had his arm thrown over the neck of a big mastiff, who was as
+happily lazy as if the summer-day had been made for him alone. As I
+eyed the pile of clothes, I could see the gleam of gold and silk
+embroidery on it, and judged that some of these workmen had tastes
+akin to those of the Golden Dustman of Hammersmith. Beside them lay
+a good big basket that had hints about it of cold pie and wine: a
+half dozen of young women stood by watching the work or the workers,
+both of which were worth watching, for the latter smote great strokes
+and were very deft in their labour, and as handsome clean-built
+fellows as you might find a dozen of in a summer day. They were
+laughing and talking merrily with each other and the women, but
+presently their foreman looked up and saw our way stopped. So he
+stayed his pick and sang out, "Spell ho, mates! here are neighbours
+want to get past." Whereon the others stopped also, and, drawing
+around us, helped the old horse by easing our wheels over the half
+undone road, and then, like men with a pleasant task on hand, hurried
+back to their work, only stopping to give us a smiling good-day; so
+that the sound of the picks broke out again before Greylocks had
+taken to his jog-trot. Dick looked back over his shoulder at them
+and said:
+
+"They are in luck to-day: it's right down good sport trying how much
+pick-work one can get into an hour; and I can see those neighbours
+know their business well. It is not a mere matter of strength
+getting on quickly with such work; is it, guest?"
+
+"I should think not," said I, "but to tell you the truth, I have
+never tried my hand at it."
+
+"Really?" said he gravely, "that seems a pity; it is good work for
+hardening the muscles, and I like it; though I admit it is pleasanter
+the second week than the first. Not that I am a good hand at it:
+the fellows used to chaff me at one job where I was working, I
+remember, and sing out to me, 'Well rowed, stroke!' 'Put your back
+into it, bow!'"
+
+"Not much of a joke," quoth I.
+
+"Well," said Dick, "everything seems like a joke when we have a
+pleasant spell of work on, and good fellows merry about us; we feels
+so happy, you know." Again I pondered silently.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII: AN OLD FRIEND
+
+
+
+We now turned into a pleasant lane where the branches of great plane-
+trees nearly met overhead, but behind them lay low houses standing
+rather close together.
+
+"This is Long Acre," quoth Dick; "so there must once have been a
+cornfield here. How curious it is that places change so, and yet
+keep their old names! Just look how thick the houses stand! and they
+are still going on building, look you!"
+
+"Yes," said the old man, "but I think the cornfields must have been
+built over before the middle of the nineteenth century. I have heard
+that about here was one of the thickest parts of the town. But I
+must get down here, neighbours; I have got to call on a friend who
+lives in the gardens behind this Long Acre. Good-bye and good luck,
+Guest!"
+
+And he jumped down and strode away vigorously, like a young man.
+
+"How old should you say that neighbour will be?" said I to Dick as we
+lost sight of him; for I saw that he was old, and yet he looked dry
+and sturdy like a piece of old oak; a type of old man I was not used
+to seeing.
+
+"O, about ninety, I should say," said Dick.
+
+"How long-lived your people must be!" said I.
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "certainly we have beaten the threescore-and-ten of
+the old Jewish proverb-book. But then you see that was written of
+Syria, a hot dry country, where people live faster than in our
+temperate climate. However, I don't think it matters much, so long
+as a man is healthy and happy while he IS alive. But now, Guest, we
+are so near to my old kinsman's dwelling-place that I think you had
+better keep all future questions for him."
+
+I nodded a yes; and therewith we turned to the left, and went down a
+gentle slope through some beautiful rose-gardens, laid out on what I
+took to be the site of Endell Street. We passed on, and Dick drew
+rein an instant as we came across a long straightish road with houses
+scantily scattered up and down it. He waved his hand right and left,
+and said, "Holborn that side, Oxford Road that. This was once a very
+important part of the crowded city outside the ancient walls of the
+Roman and Mediaeval burg: many of the feudal nobles of the Middle
+Ages, we are told, had big houses on either side of Holborn. I
+daresay you remember that the Bishop of Ely's house is mentioned in
+Shakespeare's play of King Richard III.; and there are some remains
+of that still left. However, this road is not of the same
+importance, now that the ancient city is gone, walls and all."
+
+He drove on again, while I smiled faintly to think how the nineteenth
+century, of which such big words have been said, counted for nothing
+in the memory of this man, who read Shakespeare and had not forgotten
+the Middle Ages.
+
+We crossed the road into a short narrow lane between the gardens, and
+came out again into a wide road, on one side of which was a great and
+long building, turning its gables away from the highway, which I saw
+at once was another public group. Opposite to it was a wide space of
+greenery, without any wall or fence of any kind. I looked through
+the trees and saw beyond them a pillared portico quite familiar to
+me--no less old a friend, in fact, than the British Museum. It
+rather took my breath away, amidst all the strange things I had seen;
+but I held my tongue and let Dick speak. Said he:
+
+"Yonder is the British Museum, where my great-grandfather mostly
+lives; so I won't say much about it. The building on the left is the
+Museum Market, and I think we had better turn in there for a minute
+or two; for Greylocks will be wanting his rest and his oats; and I
+suppose you will stay with my kinsman the greater part of the day;
+and to say the truth, there may be some one there whom I particularly
+want to see, and perhaps have a long talk with."
+
+He blushed and sighed, not altogether with pleasure, I thought; so of
+course I said nothing, and he turned the horse under an archway which
+brought us into a very large paved quadrangle, with a big sycamore
+tree in each corner and a plashing fountain in the midst. Near the
+fountain were a few market stalls, with awnings over them of gay
+striped linen cloth, about which some people, mostly women and
+children, were moving quietly, looking at the goods exposed there.
+The ground floor of the building round the quadrangle was occupied by
+a wide arcade or cloister, whose fanciful but strong architecture I
+could not enough admire. Here also a few people were sauntering or
+sitting reading on the benches.
+
+Dick said to me apologetically: "Here as elsewhere there is little
+doing to-day; on a Friday you would see it thronged, and gay with
+people, and in the afternoon there is generally music about the
+fountain. However, I daresay we shall have a pretty good gathering
+at our mid-day meal."
+
+We drove through the quadrangle and by an archway, into a large
+handsome stable on the other side, where we speedily stalled the old
+nag and made him happy with horse-meat, and then turned and walked
+back again through the market, Dick looking rather thoughtful, as it
+seemed to me.
+
+I noticed that people couldn't help looking at me rather hard, and
+considering my clothes and theirs, I didn't wonder; but whenever they
+caught my eye they made me a very friendly sign of greeting.
+
+We walked straight into the forecourt of the Museum, where, except
+that the railings were gone, and the whispering boughs of the trees
+were all about, nothing seemed changed; the very pigeons were
+wheeling about the building and clinging to the ornaments of the
+pediment as I had seen them of old.
+
+Dick seemed grown a little absent, but he could not forbear giving me
+an architectural note, and said:
+
+"It is rather an ugly old building, isn't it? Many people have
+wanted to pull it down and rebuild it: and perhaps if work does
+really get scarce we may yet do so. But, as my great grandfather
+will tell you, it would not be quite a straightforward job; for there
+are wonderful collections in there of all kinds of antiquities,
+besides an enormous library with many exceedingly beautiful books in
+it, and many most useful ones as genuine records, texts of ancient
+works and the like; and the worry and anxiety, and even risk, there
+would be in moving all this has saved the buildings themselves.
+Besides, as we said before, it is not a bad thing to have some record
+of what our forefathers thought a handsome building. For there is
+plenty of labour and material in it."
+
+"I see there is," said I, "and I quite agree with you. But now
+hadn't we better make haste to see your great-grandfather?"
+
+In fact, I could not help seeing that he was rather dallying with the
+time. He said, "Yes, we will go into the house in a minute. My
+kinsman is too old to do much work in the Museum, where he was a
+custodian of the books for many years; but he still lives here a good
+deal; indeed I think," said he, smiling, "that he looks upon himself
+as a part of the books, or the books a part of him, I don't know
+which."
+
+He hesitated a little longer, then flushing up, took my hand, and
+saying, "Come along, then!" led me toward the door of one of the old
+official dwellings.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX: CONCERNING LOVE
+
+
+
+"Your kinsman doesn't much care for beautiful building, then," said
+I, as we entered the rather dreary classical house; which indeed was
+as bare as need be, except for some big pots of the June flowers
+which stood about here and there; though it was very clean and nicely
+whitewashed.
+
+"O I don't know," said Dick, rather absently. "He is getting old,
+certainly, for he is over a hundred and five, and no doubt he doesn't
+care about moving. But of course he could live in a prettier house
+if he liked: he is not obliged to live in one place any more than
+any one else. This way, Guest."
+
+And he led the way upstairs, and opening a door we went into a fair-
+sized room of the old type, as plain as the rest of the house, with a
+few necessary pieces of furniture, and those very simple and even
+rude, but solid and with a good deal of carving about them, well
+designed but rather crudely executed. At the furthest corner of the
+room, at a desk near the window, sat a little old man in a roomy oak
+chair, well becushioned. He was dressed in a sort of Norfolk jacket
+of blue serge worn threadbare, with breeches of the same, and grey
+worsted stockings. He jumped up from his chair, and cried out in a
+voice of considerable volume for such an old man, "Welcome, Dick, my
+lad; Clara is here, and will be more than glad to see you; so keep
+your heart up."
+
+"Clara here?" quoth Dick; "if I had known, I would not have brought--
+At least, I mean I would--"
+
+He was stuttering and confused, clearly because he was anxious to say
+nothing to make me feel one too many. But the old man, who had not
+seen me at first, helped him out by coming forward and saying to me
+in a kind tone:
+
+"Pray pardon me, for I did not notice that Dick, who is big enough to
+hide anybody, you know, had brought a friend with him. A most hearty
+welcome to you! All the more, as I almost hope that you are going to
+amuse an old man by giving him news from over sea, for I can see that
+you are come from over the water and far off countries."
+
+He looked at me thoughtfully, almost anxiously, as he said in a
+changed voice, "Might I ask you where you come from, as you are so
+clearly a stranger?"
+
+I said in an absent way: "I used to live in England, and now I am
+come back again; and I slept last night at the Hammersmith Guest
+House."
+
+He bowed gravely, but seemed, I thought, a little disappointed with
+my answer. As for me, I was now looking at him harder than good
+manners allowed of; perhaps; for in truth his face, dried-apple-like
+as it was, seemed strangely familiar to me; as if I had seen it
+before--in a looking-glass it might be, said I to myself.
+
+"Well," said the old man, "wherever you come from, you are come among
+friends. And I see my kinsman Richard Hammond has an air about him
+as if he had brought you here for me to do something for you. Is
+that so, Dick?"
+
+Dick, who was getting still more absent-minded and kept looking
+uneasily at the door, managed to say, "Well, yes, kinsman: our guest
+finds things much altered, and cannot understand it; nor can I; so I
+thought I would bring him to you, since you know more of all that has
+happened within the last two hundred years than any body else does.--
+What's that?"
+
+And he turned toward the door again. We heard footsteps outside; the
+door opened, and in came a very beautiful young woman, who stopped
+short on seeing Dick, and flushed as red as a rose, but faced him
+nevertheless. Dick looked at her hard, and half reached out his hand
+toward her, and his whole face quivered with emotion.
+
+The old man did not leave them long in this shy discomfort, but said,
+smiling with an old man's mirth:
+
+"Dick, my lad, and you, my dear Clara, I rather think that we two
+oldsters are in your way; for I think you will have plenty to say to
+each other. You had better go into Nelson's room up above; I know he
+has gone out; and he has just been covering the walls all over with
+mediaeval books, so it will be pretty enough even for you two and
+your renewed pleasure."
+
+The girl reached out her hand to Dick, and taking his led him out of
+the room, looking straight before her; but it was easy to see that
+her blushes came from happiness, not anger; as, indeed, love is far
+more self-conscious than wrath.
+
+When the door had shut on them the old man turned to me, still
+smiling, and said:
+
+"Frankly, my dear guest, you will do me a great service if you are
+come to set my old tongue wagging. My love of talk still abides with
+me, or rather grows on me; and though it is pleasant enough to see
+these youngsters moving about and playing together so seriously, as
+if the whole world depended on their kisses (as indeed it does
+somewhat), yet I don't think my tales of the past interest them much.
+The last harvest, the last baby, the last knot of carving in the
+market-place, is history enough for them. It was different, I think,
+when I was a lad, when we were not so assured of peace and continuous
+plenty as we are now--Well, well! Without putting you to the
+question, let me ask you this: Am I to consider you as an enquirer
+who knows a little of our modern ways of life, or as one who comes
+from some place where the very foundations of life are different from
+ours,--do you know anything or nothing about us?"
+
+He looked at me keenly and with growing wonder in his eyes as he
+spoke; and I answered in a low voice:
+
+"I know only so much of your modern life as I could gather from using
+my eyes on the way here from Hammersmith, and from asking some
+questions of Richard Hammond, most of which he could hardly
+understand."
+
+The old man smiled at this. "Then," said he, "I am to speak to you
+as--"
+
+"As if I were a being from another planet," said I.
+
+The old man, whose name, by the bye, like his kinsman's, was Hammond,
+smiled and nodded, and wheeling his seat round to me, bade me sit in
+a heavy oak chair, and said, as he saw my eyes fix on its curious
+carving:
+
+"Yes, I am much tied to the past, my past, you understand. These
+very pieces of furniture belong to a time before my early days; it
+was my father who got them made; if they had been done within the
+last fifty years they would have been much cleverer in execution; but
+I don't think I should have liked them the better. We were almost
+beginning again in those days: and they were brisk, hot-headed
+times. But you hear how garrulous I am: ask me questions, ask me
+questions about anything, dear guest; since I must talk, make my talk
+profitable to you."
+
+I was silent for a minute, and then I said, somewhat nervously:
+"Excuse me if I am rude; but I am so much interested in Richard,
+since he has been so kind to me, a perfect stranger, that I should
+like to ask a question about him."
+
+"Well," said old Hammond, "if he were not 'kind', as you call it, to
+a perfect stranger he would be thought a strange person, and people
+would be apt to shun him. But ask on, ask on! don't be shy of
+asking."
+
+Said I: "That beautiful girl, is he going to be married to her?"
+
+"Well," said he, "yes, he is. He has been married to her once
+already, and now I should say it is pretty clear that he will be
+married to her again."
+
+"Indeed," quoth I, wondering what that meant.
+
+"Here is the whole tale," said old Hammond; "a short one enough; and
+now I hope a happy one: they lived together two years the first
+time; were both very young; and then she got it into her head that
+she was in love with somebody else. So she left poor Dick; I say
+POOR Dick, because he had not found any one else. But it did not
+last long, only about a year. Then she came to me, as she was in the
+habit of bringing her troubles to the old carle, and asked me how
+Dick was, and whether he was happy, and all the rest of it. So I saw
+how the land lay, and said that he was very unhappy, and not at all
+well; which last at any rate was a lie. There, you can guess the
+rest. Clara came to have a long talk with me to-day, but Dick will
+serve her turn much better. Indeed, if he hadn't chanced in upon me
+to-day I should have had to have sent for him to-morrow."
+
+"Dear me," said I. "Have they any children?"
+
+"Yes," said he, "two; they are staying with one of my daughters at
+present, where, indeed, Clara has mostly been. I wouldn't lose sight
+of her, as I felt sure they would come together again: and Dick, who
+is the best of good fellows, really took the matter to heart. You
+see, he had no other love to run to, as she had. So I managed it
+all; as I have done with such-like matters before."
+
+"Ah," said I, "no doubt you wanted to keep them out of the Divorce
+Court: but I suppose it often has to settle such matters."
+
+"Then you suppose nonsense," said he. "I know that there used to be
+such lunatic affairs as divorce-courts: but just consider; all the
+cases that came into them were matters of property quarrels: and I
+think, dear guest," said he, smiling, "that though you do come from
+another planet, you can see from the mere outside look of our world
+that quarrels about private property could not go on amongst us in
+our days."
+
+Indeed, my drive from Hammersmith to Bloomsbury, and all the quiet
+happy life I had seen so many hints of; even apart from my shopping,
+would have been enough to tell me that "the sacred rights of
+property," as we used to think of them, were now no more. So I sat
+silent while the old man took up the thread of the discourse again,
+and said:
+
+"Well, then, property quarrels being no longer possible, what remains
+in these matters that a court of law could deal with? Fancy a court
+for enforcing a contract of passion or sentiment! If such a thing
+were needed as a reductio ad absurdum of the enforcement of contract,
+such a folly would do that for us."
+
+He was silent again a little, and then said: "You must understand
+once for all that we have changed these matters; or rather, that our
+way of looking at them has changed, as we have changed within the
+last two hundred years. We do not deceive ourselves, indeed, or
+believe that we can get rid of all the trouble that besets the
+dealings between the sexes. We know that we must face the
+unhappiness that comes of man and woman confusing the relations
+between natural passion, and sentiment, and the friendship which,
+when things go well, softens the awakening from passing illusions:
+but we are not so mad as to pile up degradation on that unhappiness
+by engaging in sordid squabbles about livelihood and position, and
+the power of tyrannising over the children who have been the results
+of love or lust."
+
+Again he paused awhile, and again went on: "Calf love, mistaken for
+a heroism that shall be lifelong, yet early waning into
+disappointment; the inexplicable desire that comes on a man of riper
+years to be the all-in-all to some one woman, whose ordinary human
+kindness and human beauty he has idealised into superhuman
+perfection, and made the one object of his desire; or lastly the
+reasonable longing of a strong and thoughtful man to become the most
+intimate friend of some beautiful and wise woman, the very type of
+the beauty and glory of the world which we love so well,--as we exult
+in all the pleasure and exaltation of spirit which goes with these
+things, so we set ourselves to bear the sorrow which not unseldom
+goes with them also; remembering those lines of the ancient poet (I
+quote roughly from memory one of the many translations of the
+nineteenth century):
+
+
+'For this the Gods have fashioned man's grief and evil day
+That still for man hereafter might be the tale and the lay.'
+
+
+Well, well, 'tis little likely anyhow that all tales shall be
+lacking, or all sorrow cured."
+
+He was silent for some time, and I would not interrupt him. At last
+he began again: "But you must know that we of these generations are
+strong and healthy of body, and live easily; we pass our lives in
+reasonable strife with nature, exercising not one side of ourselves
+only, but all sides, taking the keenest pleasure in all the life of
+the world. So it is a point of honour with us not to be self-
+centred; not to suppose that the world must cease because one man is
+sorry; therefore we should think it foolish, or if you will,
+criminal, to exaggerate these matters of sentiment and sensibility:
+we are no more inclined to eke out our sentimental sorrows than to
+cherish our bodily pains; and we recognise that there are other
+pleasures besides love-making. You must remember, also, that we are
+long-lived, and that therefore beauty both in man and woman is not so
+fleeting as it was in the days when we were burdened so heavily by
+self-inflicted diseases. So we shake off these griefs in a way which
+perhaps the sentimentalists of other times would think contemptible
+and unheroic, but which we think necessary and manlike. As on the
+other hand, therefore, we have ceased to be commercial in our love-
+matters, so also we have ceased to be ARTIFICIALLY foolish. The
+folly which comes by nature, the unwisdom of the immature man, or the
+older man caught in a trap, we must put up with that, nor are we much
+ashamed of it; but to be conventionally sensitive or sentimental--my
+friend, I am old and perhaps disappointed, but at least I think we
+have cast off SOME of the follies of the older world."
+
+He paused, as if for some words of mine; but I held my peace: then
+he went on: "At least, if we suffer from the tyranny and fickleness
+of nature or our own want of experience, we neither grimace about it,
+nor lie. If there must be sundering betwixt those who meant never to
+sunder, so it must be: but there need be no pretext of unity when
+the reality of it is gone: nor do we drive those who well know that
+they are incapable of it to profess an undying sentiment which they
+cannot really feel: thus it is that as that monstrosity of venal
+lust is no longer possible, so also it is no longer needed. Don't
+misunderstand me. You did not seemed shocked when I told you that
+there were no law-courts to enforce contracts of sentiment or
+passion; but so curiously are men made, that perhaps you will be
+shocked when I tell you that there is no code of public opinion which
+takes the place of such courts, and which might be as tyrannical and
+unreasonable as they were. I do not say that people don't judge
+their neighbours' conduct, sometimes, doubtless, unfairly. But I do
+say that there is no unvarying conventional set of rules by which
+people are judged; no bed of Procrustes to stretch or cramp their
+minds and lives; no hypocritical excommunication which people are
+FORCED to pronounce, either by unconsidered habit, or by the
+unexpressed threat of the lesser interdict if they are lax in their
+hypocrisy. Are you shocked now?"
+
+"N-o--no," said I, with some hesitation. "It is all so different."
+
+"At any rate," said he, "one thing I think I can answer for:
+whatever sentiment there is, it is real--and general; it is not
+confined to people very specially refined. I am also pretty sure, as
+I hinted to you just now, that there is not by a great way as much
+suffering involved in these matters either to men or to women as
+there used to be. But excuse me for being so prolix on this
+question! You know you asked to be treated like a being from another
+planet."
+
+"Indeed I thank you very much," said I. "Now may I ask you about the
+position of women in your society?"
+
+He laughed very heartily for a man of his years, and said: "It is
+not without reason that I have got a reputation as a careful student
+of history. I believe I really do understand 'the Emancipation of
+Women movement' of the nineteenth century. I doubt if any other man
+now alive does."
+
+"Well?" said I, a little bit nettled by his merriment.
+
+"'Well," said he, "of course you will see that all that is a dead
+controversy now. The men have no longer any opportunity of
+tyrannising over the women, or the women over the men; both of which
+things took place in those old times. The women do what they can do
+best, and what they like best, and the men are neither jealous of it
+or injured by it. This is such a commonplace that I am almost
+ashamed to state it."
+
+I said, "O; and legislation? do they take any part in that?"
+
+Hammond smiled and said: "I think you may wait for an answer to that
+question till we get on to the subject of legislation. There may be
+novelties to you in that subject also."
+
+"Very well," I said; "but about this woman question? I saw at the
+Guest House that the women were waiting on the men: that seems a
+little like reaction doesn't it?"
+
+"Does it?" said the old man; "perhaps you think housekeeping an
+unimportant occupation, not deserving of respect. I believe that was
+the opinion of the 'advanced' women of the nineteenth century, and
+their male backers. If it is yours, I recommend to your notice an
+old Norwegian folk-lore tale called How the Man minded the House, or
+some such title; the result of which minding was that, after various
+tribulations, the man and the family cow balanced each other at the
+end of a rope, the man hanging halfway up the chimney, the cow
+dangling from the roof, which, after the fashion of the country, was
+of turf and sloping down low to the ground. Hard on the cow, _I_
+think. Of course no such mishap could happen to such a superior
+person as yourself," he added, chuckling.
+
+I sat somewhat uneasy under this dry gibe. Indeed, his manner of
+treating this latter part of the question seemed to me a little
+disrespectful.
+
+"Come, now, my friend," quoth he, "don't you know that it is a great
+pleasure to a clever woman to manage a house skilfully, and to do it
+so that all the house-mates about her look pleased, and are grateful
+to her? And then, you know, everybody likes to be ordered about by a
+pretty woman: why, it is one of the pleasantest forms of flirtation.
+You are not so old that you cannot remember that. Why, I remember it
+well."
+
+And the old fellow chuckled again, and at last fairly burst out
+laughing.
+
+"Excuse me," said he, after a while; "I am not laughing at anything
+you could be thinking of; but at that silly nineteenth-century
+fashion, current amongst rich so-called cultivated people, of
+ignoring all the steps by which their daily dinner was reached, as
+matters too low for their lofty intelligence. Useless idiots! Come,
+now, I am a 'literary man,' as we queer animals used to be called,
+yet I am a pretty good cook myself."
+
+"So am I," said I.
+
+"Well, then," said he, "I really think you can understand me better
+than you would seem to do, judging by your words and your silence."
+
+Said I: "Perhaps that is so; but people putting in practice commonly
+this sense of interest in the ordinary occupations of life rather
+startles me. I will ask you a question or two presently about that.
+But I want to return to the position of women amongst you. You have
+studied the 'emancipation of women' business of the nineteenth
+century: don't you remember that some of the 'superior' women wanted
+to emancipate the more intelligent part of their sex from the bearing
+of children?"
+
+The old man grew quite serious again. Said he: "I DO remember about
+that strange piece of baseless folly, the result, like all other
+follies of the period, of the hideous class tyranny which then
+obtained. What do we think of it now? you would say. My friend,
+that is a question easy to answer. How could it possibly be but that
+maternity should be highly honoured amongst us? Surely it is a
+matter of course that the natural and necessary pains which the
+mother must go through form a bond of union between man and woman, an
+extra stimulus to love and affection between them, and that this is
+universally recognised. For the rest, remember that all the
+ARTIFICIAL burdens of motherhood are now done away with. A mother
+has no longer any mere sordid anxieties for the future of her
+children. They may indeed turn out better or worse; they may
+disappoint her highest hopes; such anxieties as these are a part of
+the mingled pleasure and pain which goes to make up the life of
+mankind. But at least she is spared the fear (it was most commonly
+the certainty) that artificial disabilities would make her children
+something less than men and women: she knows that they will live and
+act according to the measure of their own faculties. In times past,
+it is clear that the 'Society' of the day helped its Judaic god, and
+the 'Man of Science' of the time, in visiting the sins of the fathers
+upon the children. How to reverse this process, how to take the
+sting out of heredity, has for long been one of the most constant
+cares of the thoughtful men amongst us. So that, you see, the
+ordinarily healthy woman (and almost all our women are both healthy
+and at least comely), respected as a child-bearer and rearer of
+children, desired as a woman, loved as a companion, unanxious for the
+future of her children, has far more instinct for maternity than the
+poor drudge and mother of drudges of past days could ever have had;
+or than her sister of the upper classes, brought up in affected
+ignorance of natural facts, reared in an atmosphere of mingled
+prudery and prurience."
+
+"You speak warmly," I said, "but I can see that you are right."
+
+"Yes," he said, "and I will point out to you a token of all the
+benefits which we have gained by our freedom. What did you think of
+the looks of the people whom you have come across to-day?"
+
+Said I: "I could hardly have believed that there could be so many
+good-looking people in any civilised country."
+
+He crowed a little, like the old bird he was. "What! are we still
+civilised?" said he. "Well, as to our looks, the English and Jutish
+blood, which on the whole is predominant here, used not to produce
+much beauty. But I think we have improved it. I know a man who has
+a large collection of portraits printed from photographs of the
+nineteenth century, and going over those and comparing them with the
+everyday faces in these times, puts the improvement in our good looks
+beyond a doubt. Now, there are some people who think it not too
+fantastic to connect this increase of beauty directly with our
+freedom and good sense in the matters we have been speaking of: they
+believe that a child born from the natural and healthy love between a
+man and a woman, even if that be transient, is likely to turn out
+better in all ways, and especially in bodily beauty, than the birth
+of the respectable commercial marriage bed, or of the dull despair of
+the drudge of that system. They say, Pleasure begets pleasure. What
+do you think?"
+
+"I am much of that mind," said I.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X: QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS
+
+
+
+"Well," said the old man, shifting in his chair, "you must get on
+with your questions, Guest; I have been some time answering this
+first one."
+
+Said I: "I want an extra word or two about your ideas of education;
+although I gathered from Dick that you let your children run wild and
+didn't teach them anything; and in short, that you have so refined
+your education, that now you have none."
+
+"Then you gathered left-handed," quoth he. "But of course I
+understand your point of view about education, which is that of times
+past, when 'the struggle for life,' as men used to phrase it (i.e.,
+the struggle for a slave's rations on one side, and for a bouncing
+share of the slave-holders' privilege on the other), pinched
+'education' for most people into a niggardly dole of not very
+accurate information; something to be swallowed by the beginner in
+the art of living whether he liked it or not, and was hungry for it
+or not: and which had been chewed and digested over and over again
+by people who didn't care about it in order to serve it out to other
+people who didn't care about it."
+
+I stopped the old man's rising wrath by a laugh, and said: "Well,
+YOU were not taught that way, at any rate, so you may let your anger
+run off you a little."
+
+"True, true," said he, smiling. "I thank you for correcting my ill-
+temper: I always fancy myself as living in any period of which we
+may be speaking. But, however, to put it in a cooler way: you
+expected to see children thrust into schools when they had reached an
+age conventionally supposed to be the due age, whatever their varying
+faculties and dispositions might be, and when there, with like
+disregard to facts to be subjected to a certain conventional course
+of 'learning.' My friend, can't you see that such a proceeding means
+ignoring the fact of GROWTH, bodily and mental? No one could come
+out of such a mill uninjured; and those only would avoid being
+crushed by it who would have the spirit of rebellion strong in them.
+Fortunately most children have had that at all times, or I do not
+know that we should ever have reached our present position. Now you
+see what it all comes to. In the old times all this was the result
+of POVERTY. In the nineteenth century, society was so miserably
+poor, owing to the systematised robbery on which it was founded, that
+real education was impossible for anybody. The whole theory of their
+so-called education was that it was necessary to shove a little
+information into a child, even if it were by means of torture, and
+accompanied by twaddle which it was well known was of no use, or else
+he would lack information lifelong: the hurry of poverty forbade
+anything else. All that is past; we are no longer hurried, and the
+information lies ready to each one's hand when his own inclinations
+impel him to seek it. In this as in other matters we have become
+wealthy: we can afford to give ourselves time to grow."
+
+"Yes," said I, "but suppose the child, youth, man, never wants the
+information, never grows in the direction you might hope him to do:
+suppose, for instance, he objects to learning arithmetic or
+mathematics; you can't force him when he IS grown; can't you force
+him while he is growing, and oughtn't you to do so?"
+
+"Well," said he, "were you forced to learn arithmetic and
+mathematics?"
+
+"A little," said I.
+
+"And how old are you now?"
+
+"Say fifty-six," said I.
+
+"And how much arithmetic and mathematics do you know now?" quoth the
+old man, smiling rather mockingly.
+
+Said I: "None whatever, I am sorry to say."
+
+Hammond laughed quietly, but made no other comment on my admission,
+and I dropped the subject of education, perceiving him to be hopeless
+on that side.
+
+I thought a little, and said: "You were speaking just now of
+households: that sounded to me a little like the customs of past
+times; I should have thought you would have lived more in public."
+
+"Phalangsteries, eh?" said he. "Well, we live as we like, and we
+like to live as a rule with certain house-mates that we have got used
+to. Remember, again, that poverty is extinct, and that the
+Fourierist phalangsteries and all their kind, as was but natural at
+the time, implied nothing but a refuge from mere destitution. Such a
+way of life as that, could only have been conceived of by people
+surrounded by the worst form of poverty. But you must understand
+therewith, that though separate households are the rule amongst us,
+and though they differ in their habits more or less, yet no door is
+shut to any good-tempered person who is content to live as the other
+house-mates do: only of course it would be unreasonable for one man
+to drop into a household and bid the folk of it to alter their habits
+to please him, since he can go elsewhere and live as he pleases.
+However, I need not say much about all this, as you are going up the
+river with Dick, and will find out for yourself by experience how
+these matters are managed."
+
+After a pause, I said: "Your big towns, now; how about them?
+London, which--which I have read about as the modern Babylon of
+civilization, seems to have disappeared."
+
+"Well, well," said old Hammond, "perhaps after all it is more like
+ancient Babylon now than the 'modern Babylon' of the nineteenth
+century was. But let that pass. After all, there is a good deal of
+population in places between here and Hammersmith; nor have you seen
+the most populous part of the town yet."
+
+"Tell me, then," said I, "how is it towards the east?"
+
+Said he: "Time was when if you mounted a good horse and rode
+straight away from my door here at a round trot for an hour and a
+half; you would still be in the thick of London, and the greater part
+of that would be 'slums,' as they were called; that is to say, places
+of torture for innocent men and women; or worse, stews for rearing
+and breeding men and women in such degradation that that torture
+should seem to them mere ordinary and natural life."
+
+"I know, I know," I said, rather impatiently. "That was what was;
+tell me something of what is. Is any of that left?"
+
+"Not an inch," said he; "but some memory of it abides with us, and I
+am glad of it. Once a year, on May-day, we hold a solemn feast in
+those easterly communes of London to commemorate The Clearing of
+Misery, as it is called. On that day we have music and dancing, and
+merry games and happy feasting on the site of some of the worst of
+the old slums, the traditional memory of which we have kept. On that
+occasion the custom is for the prettiest girls to sing some of the
+old revolutionary songs, and those which were the groans of the
+discontent, once so hopeless, on the very spots where those terrible
+crimes of class-murder were committed day by day for so many years.
+To a man like me, who have studied the past so diligently, it is a
+curious and touching sight to see some beautiful girl, daintily clad,
+and crowned with flowers from the neighbouring meadows, standing
+amongst the happy people, on some mound where of old time stood the
+wretched apology for a house, a den in which men and women lived
+packed amongst the filth like pilchards in a cask; lived in such a
+way that they could only have endured it, as I said just now, by
+being degraded out of humanity--to hear the terrible words of
+threatening and lamentation coming from her sweet and beautiful lips,
+and she unconscious of their real meaning: to hear her, for
+instance, singing Hood's Song of the Shirt, and to think that all the
+time she does not understand what it is all about--a tragedy grown
+inconceivable to her and her listeners. Think of that, if you can,
+and of how glorious life is grown!"
+
+"Indeed," said I, "it is difficult for me to think of it."
+
+And I sat watching how his eyes glittered, and how the fresh life
+seemed to glow in his face, and I wondered how at his age he should
+think of the happiness of the world, or indeed anything but his
+coming dinner.
+
+"Tell me in detail," said I, "what lies east of Bloomsbury now?"
+
+Said he: "There are but few houses between this and the outer part
+of the old city; but in the city we have a thickly-dwelling
+population. Our forefathers, in the first clearing of the slums,
+were not in a hurry to pull down the houses in what was called at the
+end of the nineteenth century the business quarter of the town, and
+what later got to be known as the Swindling Kens. You see, these
+houses, though they stood hideously thick on the ground, were roomy
+and fairly solid in building, and clean, because they were not used
+for living in, but as mere gambling booths; so the poor people from
+the cleared slums took them for lodgings and dwelt there, till the
+folk of those days had time to think of something better for them; so
+the buildings were pulled down so gradually that people got used to
+living thicker on the ground there than in most places; therefore it
+remains the most populous part of London, or perhaps of all these
+islands. But it is very pleasant there, partly because of the
+splendour of the architecture, which goes further than what you will
+see elsewhere. However, this crowding, if it may be called so, does
+not go further than a street called Aldgate, a name which perhaps you
+may have heard of. Beyond that the houses are scattered wide about
+the meadows there, which are very beautiful, especially when you get
+on to the lovely river Lea (where old Isaak Walton used to fish, you
+know) about the places called Stratford and Old Ford, names which of
+course you will not have heard of, though the Romans were busy there
+once upon a time."
+
+Not heard of them! thought I to myself. How strange! that I who had
+seen the very last remnant of the pleasantness of the meadows by the
+Lea destroyed, should have heard them spoken of with pleasantness
+come back to them in full measure.
+
+Hammond went on: "When you get down to the Thames side you come on
+the Docks, which are works of the nineteenth century, and are still
+in use, although not so thronged as they once were, since we
+discourage centralisation all we can, and we have long ago dropped
+the pretension to be the market of the world. About these Docks are
+a good few houses, which, however, are not inhabited by many people
+permanently; I mean, those who use them come and go a good deal, the
+place being too low and marshy for pleasant dwelling. Past the Docks
+eastward and landward it is all flat pasture, once marsh, except for
+a few gardens, and there are very few permanent dwellings there:
+scarcely anything but a few sheds, and cots for the men who come to
+look after the great herds of cattle pasturing there. But however,
+what with the beasts and the men, and the scattered red-tiled roofs
+and the big hayricks, it does not make a bad holiday to get a quiet
+pony and ride about there on a sunny afternoon of autumn, and look
+over the river and the craft passing up and down, and on to Shooters'
+Hill and the Kentish uplands, and then turn round to the wide green
+sea of the Essex marsh-land, with the great domed line of the sky,
+and the sun shining down in one flood of peaceful light over the long
+distance. There is a place called Canning's Town, and further out,
+Silvertown, where the pleasant meadows are at their pleasantest:
+doubtless they were once slums, and wretched enough."
+
+The names grated on my ear, but I could not explain why to him. So I
+said: "And south of the river, what is it like?"
+
+He said: "You would find it much the same as the land about
+Hammersmith. North, again, the land runs up high, and there is an
+agreeable and well-built town called Hampstead, which fitly ends
+London on that side. It looks down on the north-western end of the
+forest you passed through."
+
+I smiled. "So much for what was once London," said I. "Now tell me
+about the other towns of the country."
+
+He said: "As to the big murky places which were once, as we know,
+the centres of manufacture, they have, like the brick and mortar
+desert of London, disappeared; only, since they were centres of
+nothing but 'manufacture,' and served no purpose but that of the
+gambling market, they have left less signs of their existence than
+London. Of course, the great change in the use of mechanical force
+made this an easy matter, and some approach to their break-up as
+centres would probably have taken place, even if we had not changed
+our habits so much: but they being such as they were, no sacrifice
+would have seemed too great a price to pay for getting rid of the
+'manufacturing districts,' as they used to be called. For the rest,
+whatever coal or mineral we need is brought to grass and sent whither
+it is needed with as little as possible of dirt, confusion, and the
+distressing of quiet people's lives. One is tempted to believe from
+what one has read of the condition of those districts in the
+nineteenth century, that those who had them under their power
+worried, befouled, and degraded men out of malice prepense: but it
+was not so; like the mis-education of which we were talking just now,
+it came of their dreadful poverty. They were obliged to put up with
+everything, and even pretend that they liked it; whereas we can now
+deal with things reasonably, and refuse to be saddled with what we do
+not want."
+
+I confess I was not sorry to cut short with a question his
+glorifications of the age he lived in. Said I: "How about the
+smaller towns? I suppose you have swept those away entirely?"
+
+"No, no," said he, "it hasn't gone that way. On the contrary, there
+has been but little clearance, though much rebuilding, in the smaller
+towns. Their suburbs, indeed, when they had any, have melted away
+into the general country, and space and elbow-room has been got in
+their centres: but there are the towns still with their streets and
+squares and market-places; so that it is by means of these smaller
+towns that we of to-day can get some kind of idea of what the towns
+of the older world were like;--I mean to say at their best."
+
+"Take Oxford, for instance," said I.
+
+"Yes," said he, "I suppose Oxford was beautiful even in the
+nineteenth century. At present it has the great interest of still
+preserving a great mass of pre-commercial building, and is a very
+beautiful place, yet there are many towns which have become scarcely
+less beautiful."
+
+Said I: "In passing, may I ask if it is still a place of learning?"
+
+"Still?" said he, smiling. "Well, it has reverted to some of its
+best traditions; so you may imagine how far it is from its
+nineteenth-century position. It is real learning, knowledge
+cultivated for its own sake--the Art of Knowledge, in short--which is
+followed there, not the Commercial learning of the past. Though
+perhaps you do not know that in the nineteenth century Oxford and its
+less interesting sister Cambridge became definitely commercial. They
+(and especially Oxford) were the breeding places of a peculiar class
+of parasites, who called themselves cultivated people; they were
+indeed cynical enough, as the so-called educated classes of the day
+generally were; but they affected an exaggeration of cynicism in
+order that they might be thought knowing and worldly-wise. The rich
+middle classes (they had no relation with the working classes)
+treated them with the kind of contemptuous toleration with which a
+mediaeval baron treated his jester; though it must be said that they
+were by no means so pleasant as the old jesters were, being, in fact,
+THE bores of society. They were laughed at, despised--and paid.
+Which last was what they aimed at."
+
+Dear me! thought I, how apt history is to reverse contemporary
+judgments. Surely only the worst of them were as bad as that. But I
+must admit that they were mostly prigs, and that they WERE
+commercial. I said aloud, though more to myself than to Hammond,
+"Well, how could they be better than the age that made them?"
+
+"True," he said, "but their pretensions were higher."
+
+"Were they?" said I, smiling.
+
+"You drive me from corner to corner," said he, smiling in turn. "Let
+me say at least that they were a poor sequence to the aspirations of
+Oxford of 'the barbarous Middle Ages.'"
+
+"Yes, that will do," said I.
+
+"Also," said Hammond, "what I have been saying of them is true in the
+main. But ask on!"
+
+I said: "We have heard about London and the manufacturing districts
+and the ordinary towns: how about the villages?"
+
+Said Hammond: "You must know that toward the end of the nineteenth
+century the villages were almost destroyed, unless where they became
+mere adjuncts to the manufacturing districts, or formed a sort of
+minor manufacturing districts themselves. Houses were allowed to
+fall into decay and actual ruin; trees were cut down for the sake of
+the few shillings which the poor sticks would fetch; the building
+became inexpressibly mean and hideous. Labour was scarce; but wages
+fell nevertheless. All the small country arts of life which once
+added to the little pleasures of country people were lost. The
+country produce which passed through the hands of the husbandmen
+never got so far as their mouths. Incredible shabbiness and
+niggardly pinching reigned over the fields and acres which, in spite
+of the rude and careless husbandry of the times, were so kind and
+bountiful. Had you any inkling of all this?"
+
+"I have heard that it was so," said I "but what followed?"
+
+"The change," said Hammond, "which in these matters took place very
+early in our epoch, was most strangely rapid. People flocked into
+the country villages, and, so to say, flung themselves upon the freed
+land like a wild beast upon his prey; and in a very little time the
+villages of England were more populous than they had been since the
+fourteenth century, and were still growing fast. Of course, this
+invasion of the country was awkward to deal with, and would have
+created much misery, if the folk had still been under the bondage of
+class monopoly. But as it was, things soon righted themselves.
+People found out what they were fit for, and gave up attempting to
+push themselves into occupations in which they must needs fail. The
+town invaded the country; but the invaders, like the warlike invaders
+of early days, yielded to the influence of their surroundings, and
+became country people; and in their turn, as they became more
+numerous than the townsmen, influenced them also; so that the
+difference between town and country grew less and less; and it was
+indeed this world of the country vivified by the thought and
+briskness of town-bred folk which has produced that happy and
+leisurely but eager life of which you have had a first taste. Again
+I say, many blunders were made, but we have had time to set them
+right. Much was left for the men of my earlier life to deal with.
+The crude ideas of the first half of the twentieth century, when men
+were still oppressed by the fear of poverty, and did not look enough
+to the present pleasure of ordinary daily life, spoilt a great deal
+of what the commercial age had left us of external beauty: and I
+admit that it was but slowly that men recovered from the injuries
+that they inflicted on themselves even after they became free. But
+slowly as the recovery came, it DID come; and the more you see of us,
+the clearer it will be to you that we are happy. That we live amidst
+beauty without any fear of becoming effeminate; that we have plenty
+to do, and on the whole enjoy doing it. What more can we ask of
+life?"
+
+He paused, as if he were seeking for words with which to express his
+thought. Then he said:
+
+"This is how we stand. England was once a country of clearings
+amongst the woods and wastes, with a few towns interspersed, which
+were fortresses for the feudal army, markets for the folk, gathering
+places for the craftsmen. It then became a country of huge and foul
+workshops and fouler gambling-dens, surrounded by an ill-kept,
+poverty-stricken farm, pillaged by the masters of the workshops. It
+is now a garden, where nothing is wasted and nothing is spoilt, with
+the necessary dwellings, sheds, and workshops scattered up and down
+the country, all trim and neat and pretty. For, indeed, we should be
+too much ashamed of ourselves if we allowed the making of goods, even
+on a large scale, to carry with it the appearance, even, of
+desolation and misery. Why, my friend, those housewives we were
+talking of just now would teach us better than that."
+
+Said I: "This side of your change is certainly for the better. But
+though I shall soon see some of these villages, tell me in a word or
+two what they are like, just to prepare me."
+
+"Perhaps," said he, "you have seen a tolerable picture of these
+villages as they were before the end of the nineteenth century. Such
+things exist."
+
+"I have seen several of such pictures," said I.
+
+"Well," said Hammond, "our villages are something like the best of
+such places, with the church or mote-house of the neighbours for
+their chief building. Only note that there are no tokens of poverty
+about them: no tumble-down picturesque; which, to tell you the
+truth, the artist usually availed himself of to veil his incapacity
+for drawing architecture. Such things do not please us, even when
+they indicate no misery. Like the mediaevals, we like everything
+trim and clean, and orderly and bright; as people always do when they
+have any sense of architectural power; because then they know that
+they can have what they want, and they won't stand any nonsense from
+Nature in their dealings with her."
+
+"Besides the villages, are there any scattered country houses?" said
+I.
+
+"Yes, plenty," said Hammond; "in fact, except in the wastes and
+forests and amongst the sand-hills (like Hindhead in Surrey), it is
+not easy to be out of sight of a house; and where the houses are
+thinly scattered they run large, and are more like the old colleges
+than ordinary houses as they used to be. That is done for the sake
+of society, for a good many people can dwell in such houses, as the
+country dwellers are not necessarily husbandmen; though they almost
+all help in such work at times. The life that goes on in these big
+dwellings in the country is very pleasant, especially as some of the
+most studious men of our time live in them, and altogether there is a
+great variety of mind and mood to be found in them which brightens
+and quickens the society there."
+
+"I am rather surprised," said I, "by all this, for it seems to me
+that after all the country must be tolerably populous."
+
+"Certainly," said he; "the population is pretty much the same as it
+was at the end of the nineteenth century; we have spread it, that is
+all. Of course, also, we have helped to populate other countries--
+where we were wanted and were called for."
+
+Said I: "One thing, it seems to me, does not go with your word of
+'garden' for the country. You have spoken of wastes and forests, and
+I myself have seen the beginning of your Middlesex and Essex forest.
+Why do you keep such things in a garden? and isn't it very wasteful
+to do so?"
+
+"My friend," he said, "we like these pieces of wild nature, and can
+afford them, so we have them; let alone that as to the forests, we
+need a great deal of timber, and suppose that our sons and sons' sons
+will do the like. As to the land being a garden, I have heard that
+they used to have shrubberies and rockeries in gardens once; and
+though I might not like the artificial ones, I assure you that some
+of the natural rockeries of our garden are worth seeing. Go north
+this summer and look at the Cumberland and Westmoreland ones,--where,
+by the way, you will see some sheep-feeding, so that they are not so
+wasteful as you think; not so wasteful as forcing-grounds for fruit
+out of season, _I_ think. Go and have a look at the sheep-walks high
+up the slopes between Ingleborough and Pen-y-gwent, and tell me if
+you think we WASTE the land there by not covering it with factories
+for making things that nobody wants, which was the chief business of
+the nineteenth century."
+
+"I will try to go there," said I.
+
+"It won't take much trying," said he.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI: CONCERNING GOVERNMENT
+
+
+
+"Now," said I, "I have come to the point of asking questions which I
+suppose will be dry for you to answer and difficult for you to
+explain; but I have foreseen for some time past that I must ask them,
+will I 'nill I. What kind of a government have you? Has
+republicanism finally triumphed? or have you come to a mere
+dictatorship, which some persons in the nineteenth century used to
+prophesy as the ultimate outcome of democracy? Indeed, this last
+question does not seem so very unreasonable, since you have turned
+your Parliament House into a dung-market. Or where do you house your
+present Parliament?"
+
+The old man answered my smile with a hearty laugh, and said: "Well,
+well, dung is not the worst kind of corruption; fertility may come of
+that, whereas mere dearth came from the other kind, of which those
+walls once held the great supporters. Now, dear guest, let me tell
+you that our present parliament would be hard to house in one place,
+because the whole people is our parliament."
+
+"I don't understand," said I.
+
+"No, I suppose not," said he. "I must now shock you by telling you
+that we have no longer anything which you, a native of another
+planet, would call a government."
+
+"I am not so much shocked as you might think," said I, "as I know
+something about governments. But tell me, how do you manage, and how
+have you come to this state of things?"
+
+Said he: "It is true that we have to make some arrangements about
+our affairs, concerning which you can ask presently; and it is also
+true that everybody does not always agree with the details of these
+arrangements; but, further, it is true that a man no more needs an
+elaborate system of government, with its army, navy, and police, to
+force him to give way to the will of the majority of his EQUALS, than
+he wants a similar machinery to make him understand that his head and
+a stone wall cannot occupy the same space at the same moment. Do you
+want further explanation?"
+
+"Well, yes, I do," quoth I.
+
+Old Hammond settled himself in his chair with a look of enjoyment
+which rather alarmed me, and made me dread a scientific disquisition:
+so I sighed and abided. He said:
+
+"I suppose you know pretty well what the process of government was in
+the bad old times?"
+
+"I am supposed to know," said I.
+
+(Hammond) What was the government of those days? Was it really the
+Parliament or any part of it?
+
+(I) No.
+
+(H.) Was not the Parliament on the one side a kind of watch-
+committee sitting to see that the interests of the Upper Classes took
+no hurt; and on the other side a sort of blind to delude the people
+into supposing that they had some share in the management of their
+own affairs?
+
+(I) History seems to show us this.
+
+(H.) To what extent did the people manage their own affairs?
+
+(I) I judge from what I have heard that sometimes they forced the
+Parliament to make a law to legalise some alteration which had
+already taken place.
+
+(H.) Anything else?
+
+(I) I think not. As I am informed, if the people made any attempt
+to deal with the CAUSE of their grievances, the law stepped in and
+said, this is sedition, revolt, or what not, and slew or tortured the
+ringleaders of such attempts.
+
+(H.) If Parliament was not the government then, nor the people
+either, what was the government?
+
+(I) Can you tell me?
+
+(H.) I think we shall not be far wrong if we say that government was
+the Law-Courts, backed up by the executive, which handled the brute
+force that the deluded people allowed them to use for their own
+purposes; I mean the army, navy, and police.
+
+(I) Reasonable men must needs think you are right.
+
+(H.) Now as to those Law-Courts. Were they places of fair dealing
+according to the ideas of the day? Had a poor man a good chance of
+defending his property and person in them?
+
+(I) It is a commonplace that even rich men looked upon a law-suit as
+a dire misfortune, even if they gained the case; and as for a poor
+one--why, it was considered a miracle of justice and beneficence if a
+poor man who had once got into the clutches of the law escaped prison
+or utter ruin.
+
+(H.) It seems, then, my son, that the government by law-courts and
+police, which was the real government of the nineteenth century, was
+not a great success even to the people of that day, living under a
+class system which proclaimed inequality and poverty as the law of
+God and the bond which held the world together.
+
+(I) So it seems, indeed.
+
+(H.) And now that all this is changed, and the "rights of property,"
+which mean the clenching the fist on a piece of goods and crying out
+to the neighbours, You shan't have this!--now that all this has
+disappeared so utterly that it is no longer possible even to jest
+upon its absurdity, is such a Government possible?
+
+(I) It is impossible.
+
+(H.) Yes, happily. But for what other purpose than the protection
+of the rich from the poor, the strong from the weak, did this
+Government exist?
+
+(I.) I have heard that it was said that their office was to defend
+their own citizens against attack from other countries.
+
+(H.) It was said; but was anyone expected to believe this? For
+instance, did the English Government defend the English citizen
+against the French?
+
+(I) So it was said.
+
+(H.) Then if the French had invaded England and conquered it, they
+would not have allowed the English workmen to live well?
+
+(I, laughing) As far as I can make out, the English masters of the
+English workmen saw to that: they took from their workmen as much of
+their livelihood as they dared, because they wanted it for
+themselves.
+
+(H.) But if the French had conquered, would they not have taken more
+still from the English workmen?
+
+(I) I do not think so; for in that case the English workmen would
+have died of starvation; and then the French conquest would have
+ruined the French, just as if the English horses and cattle had died
+of under-feeding. So that after all, the English WORKMEN would have
+been no worse off for the conquest: their French Masters could have
+got no more from them than their English masters did.
+
+(H.) This is true; and we may admit that the pretensions of the
+government to defend the poor (i.e., the useful) people against other
+countries come to nothing. But that is but natural; for we have seen
+already that it was the function of government to protect the rich
+against the poor. But did not the government defend its rich men
+against other nations?
+
+(I) I do not remember to have heard that the rich needed defence;
+because it is said that even when two nations were at war, the rich
+men of each nation gambled with each other pretty much as usual, and
+even sold each other weapons wherewith to kill their own countrymen.
+
+(H.) In short, it comes to this, that whereas the so-called
+government of protection of property by means of the law-courts meant
+destruction of wealth, this defence of the citizens of one country
+against those of another country by means of war or the threat of war
+meant pretty much the same thing.
+
+(I) I cannot deny it.
+
+(H.) Therefore the government really existed for the destruction of
+wealth?
+
+(I) So it seems. And yet -
+
+(H.) Yet what?
+
+(I) There were many rich people in those times.
+
+(H.) You see the consequences of that fact?
+
+(I) I think I do. But tell me out what they were.
+
+(H.) If the government habitually destroyed wealth, the country must
+have been poor?
+
+(I) Yes, certainly.
+
+(H.) Yet amidst this poverty the persons for the sake of whom the
+government existed insisted on being rich whatever might happen?
+
+(I) So it was.
+
+(H.) What must happen if in a poor country some people insist on
+being rich at the expense of the others?
+
+(I) Unutterable poverty for the others. All this misery, then, was
+caused by the destructive government of which we have been speaking?
+
+(H.) Nay, it would be incorrect to say so. The government itself
+was but the necessary result of the careless, aimless tyranny of the
+times; it was but the machinery of tyranny. Now tyranny has come to
+an end, and we no longer need such machinery; we could not possibly
+use it since we are free. Therefore in your sense of the word we
+have no government. Do you understand this now?
+
+(I) Yes, I do. But I will ask you some more questions as to how you
+as free men manage your affairs.
+
+(H.) With all my heart. Ask away.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII: CONCERNING THE ARRANGEMENT OF LIFE
+
+
+
+"Well," I said, "about those 'arrangements' which you spoke of as
+taking the place of government, could you give me any account of
+them?"
+
+"Neighbour," he said, "although we have simplified our lives a great
+deal from what they were, and have got rid of many conventionalities
+and many sham wants, which used to give our forefathers much trouble,
+yet our life is too complex for me to tell you in detail by means of
+words how it is arranged; you must find that out by living amongst
+us. It is true that I can better tell you what we don't do, than
+what we do do."
+
+"Well?" said I.
+
+"This is the way to put it," said he: "We have been living for a
+hundred and fifty years, at least, more or less in our present
+manner, and a tradition or habit of life has been growing on us; and
+that habit has become a habit of acting on the whole for the best.
+It is easy for us to live without robbing each other. It would be
+possible for us to contend with and rob each other, but it would be
+harder for us than refraining from strife and robbery. That is in
+short the foundation of our life and our happiness."
+
+"Whereas in the old days," said I, "it was very hard to live without
+strife and robbery. That's what you mean, isn't it, by giving me the
+negative side of your good conditions?"
+
+"Yes," he said, "it was so hard, that those who habitually acted
+fairly to their neighbours were celebrated as saints and heroes, and
+were looked up to with the greatest reverence."
+
+"While they were alive?" said I.
+
+"No," said he, "after they were dead."
+
+"But as to these days," I said; "you don't mean to tell me that no
+one ever transgresses this habit of good fellowship?"
+
+"Certainly not," said Hammond, "but when the transgressions occur,
+everybody, transgressors and all, know them for what they are; the
+errors of friends, not the habitual actions of persons driven into
+enmity against society."
+
+"I see," said I; "you mean that you have no 'criminal' classes."
+
+"How could we have them," said he, "since there is no rich class to
+breed enemies against the state by means of the injustice of the
+state?"
+
+Said I: "I thought that I understood from something that fell from
+you a little while ago that you had abolished civil law. Is that so,
+literally?"
+
+"It abolished itself, my friend," said he. "As I said before, the
+civil law-courts were upheld for the defence of private property; for
+nobody ever pretended that it was possible to make people act fairly
+to each other by means of brute force. Well, private property being
+abolished, all the laws and all the legal 'crimes' which it had
+manufactured of course came to an end. Thou shalt not steal, had to
+be translated into, Thou shalt work in order to live happily. Is
+there any need to enforce that commandment by violence?"
+
+"Well," said I, "that is understood, and I agree with it; but how
+about crimes of violence? would not their occurrence (and you admit
+that they occur) make criminal law necessary?"
+
+Said he: "In your sense of the word, we have no criminal law either.
+Let us look at the matter closer, and see whence crimes of violence
+spring. By far the greater part of these in past days were the
+result of the laws of private property, which forbade the
+satisfaction of their natural desires to all but a privileged few,
+and of the general visible coercion which came of those laws. All
+that cause of violent crime is gone. Again, many violent acts came
+from the artificial perversion of the sexual passions, which caused
+overweening jealousy and the like miseries. Now, when you look
+carefully into these, you will find that what lay at the bottom of
+them was mostly the idea (a law-made idea) of the woman being the
+property of the man, whether he were husband, father, brother, or
+what not. That idea has of course vanished with private property, as
+well as certain follies about the 'ruin' of women for following their
+natural desires in an illegal way, which of course was a convention
+caused by the laws of private property.
+
+"Another cognate cause of crimes of violence was the family tyranny,
+which was the subject of so many novels and stories of the past, and
+which once more was the result of private property. Of course that
+is all ended, since families are held together by no bond of
+coercion, legal or social, but by mutual liking and affection, and
+everybody is free to come or go as he or she pleases. Furthermore,
+our standards of honour and public estimation are very different from
+the old ones; success in besting our neighbours is a road to renown
+now closed, let us hope for ever. Each man is free to exercise his
+special faculty to the utmost, and every one encourages him in so
+doing. So that we have got rid of the scowling envy, coupled by the
+poets with hatred, and surely with good reason; heaps of unhappiness
+and ill-blood were caused by it, which with irritable and passionate
+men--i.e., energetic and active men--often led to violence."
+
+I laughed, and said: "So that you now withdraw your admission, and
+say that there is no violence amongst you?"
+
+"No," said he, "I withdraw nothing; as I told you, such things will
+happen. Hot blood will err sometimes. A man may strike another, and
+the stricken strike back again, and the result be a homicide, to put
+it at the worst. But what then? Shall we the neighbours make it
+worse still? Shall we think so poorly of each other as to suppose
+that the slain man calls on us to revenge him, when we know that if
+he had been maimed, he would, when in cold blood and able to weigh
+all the circumstances, have forgiven his manner? Or will the death
+of the slayer bring the slain man to life again and cure the
+unhappiness his loss has caused?"
+
+"Yes," I said, "but consider, must not the safety of society be
+safeguarded by some punishment?"
+
+"There, neighbour!" said the old man, with some exultation "You have
+hit the mark. That PUNISHMENT of which men used to talk so wisely
+and act so foolishly, what was it but the expression of their fear?
+And they had need to fear, since they--i.e., the rulers of society--
+were dwelling like an armed band in a hostile country. But we who
+live amongst our friends need neither fear nor punish. Surely if we,
+in dread of an occasional rare homicide, an occasional rough blow,
+were solemnly and legally to commit homicide and violence, we could
+only be a society of ferocious cowards. Don't you think so,
+neighbour?"
+
+"Yes, I do, when I come to think of it from that side," said I.
+
+"Yet you must understand," said the old man, "that when any violence
+is committed, we expect the transgressor to make any atonement
+possible to him, and he himself expects it. But again, think if the
+destruction or serious injury of a man momentarily overcome by wrath
+or folly can be any atonement to the commonwealth? Surely it can
+only be an additional injury to it."
+
+Said I: "But suppose the man has a habit of violence,--kills a man a
+year, for instance?"
+
+"Such a thing is unknown," said he. "In a society where there is no
+punishment to evade, no law to triumph over, remorse will certainly
+follow transgression."
+
+"And lesser outbreaks of violence," said I, "how do you deal with
+them? for hitherto we have been talking of great tragedies, I
+suppose?"
+
+Said Hammond: "If the ill-doer is not sick or mad (in which case he
+must be restrained till his sickness or madness is cured) it is clear
+that grief and humiliation must follow the ill-deed; and society in
+general will make that pretty clear to the ill-doer if he should
+chance to be dull to it; and again, some kind of atonement will
+follow,--at the least, an open acknowledgement of the grief and
+humiliation. Is it so hard to say, I ask your pardon, neighbour?--
+Well, sometimes it is hard--and let it be."
+
+"You think that enough?" said I.
+
+"Yes," said he, "and moreover it is all that we CAN do. If in
+addition we torture the man, we turn his grief into anger, and the
+humiliation he would otherwise feel for HIS wrong-doing is swallowed
+up by a hope of revenge for OUR wrong-doing to him. He has paid the
+legal penalty, and can 'go and sin again' with comfort. Shall we
+commit such a folly, then? Remember Jesus had got the legal penalty
+remitted before he said 'Go and sin no more.' Let alone that in a
+society of equals you will not find any one to play the part of
+torturer or jailer, though many to act as nurse or doctor."
+
+"So," said I, "you consider crime a mere spasmodic disease, which
+requires no body of criminal law to deal with it?"
+
+"Pretty much so," said he; "and since, as I have told you, we are a
+healthy people generally, so we are not likely to be much troubled
+with THIS disease."
+
+"Well, you have no civil law, and no criminal law. But have you no
+laws of the market, so to say--no regulation for the exchange of
+wares? for you must exchange, even if you have no property."
+
+Said he: "We have no obvious individual exchange, as you saw this
+morning when you went a-shopping; but of course there are regulations
+of the markets, varying according to the circumstances and guided by
+general custom. But as these are matters of general assent, which
+nobody dreams of objecting to, so also we have made no provision for
+enforcing them: therefore I don't call them laws. In law, whether
+it be criminal or civil, execution always follows judgment, and
+someone must suffer. When you see the judge on his bench, you see
+through him, as clearly as if he were made of glass, the policeman to
+emprison, and the soldier to slay some actual living person. Such
+follies would make an agreeable market, wouldn't they?"
+
+"Certainly," said I, "that means turning the market into a mere
+battle-field, in which many people must suffer as much as in the
+battle-field of bullet and bayonet. And from what I have seen I
+should suppose that your marketing, great and little, is carried on
+in a way that makes it a pleasant occupation."
+
+"You are right, neighbour," said he. "Although there are so many,
+indeed by far the greater number amongst us, who would be unhappy if
+they were not engaged in actually making things, and things which
+turn out beautiful under their hands,--there are many, like the
+housekeepers I was speaking of, whose delight is in administration
+and organisation, to use long-tailed words; I mean people who like
+keeping things together, avoiding waste, seeing that nothing sticks
+fast uselessly. Such people are thoroughly happy in their business,
+all the more as they are dealing with actual facts, and not merely
+passing counters round to see what share they shall have in the
+privileged taxation of useful people, which was the business of the
+commercial folk in past days. Well, what are you going to ask me
+next?"
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII: CONCERNING POLITICS
+
+
+
+Said I: "How do you manage with politics?"
+
+Said Hammond, smiling: "I am glad that it is of ME that you ask that
+question; I do believe that anybody else would make you explain
+yourself, or try to do so, till you were sickened of asking
+questions. Indeed, I believe I am the only man in England who would
+know what you mean; and since I know, I will answer your question
+briefly by saying that we are very well off as to politics,--because
+we have none. If ever you make a book out of this conversation, put
+this in a chapter by itself, after the model of old Horrebow's Snakes
+in Iceland."
+
+"I will," said I.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV: HOW MATTERS ARE MANAGED
+
+
+
+Said I: "How about your relations with foreign nations?"
+
+"I will not affect not to know what you mean," said he, "but I will
+tell you at once that the whole system of rival and contending
+nations which played so great a part in the 'government' of the world
+of civilisation has disappeared along with the inequality betwixt man
+and man in society."
+
+"Does not that make the world duller?" said I.
+
+"Why?" said the old man.
+
+"The obliteration of national variety," said I.
+
+"Nonsense," he said, somewhat snappishly. "Cross the water and see.
+You will find plenty of variety: the landscape, the building, the
+diet, the amusements, all various. The men and women varying in
+looks as well as in habits of thought; the costume far more various
+than in the commercial period. How should it add to the variety or
+dispel the dulness, to coerce certain families or tribes, often
+heterogeneous and jarring with one another, into certain artificial
+and mechanical groups, and call them nations, and stimulate their
+patriotism--i.e., their foolish and envious prejudices?"
+
+"Well--I don't know how," said I.
+
+"That's right," said Hammond cheerily; "you can easily understand
+that now we are freed from this folly it is obvious to us that by
+means of this very diversity the different strains of blood in the
+world can be serviceable and pleasant to each other, without in the
+least wanting to rob each other: we are all bent on the same
+enterprise, making the most of our lives. And I must tell you
+whatever quarrels or misunderstandings arise, they very seldom take
+place between people of different race; and consequently since there
+is less unreason in them, they are the more readily appeased."
+
+"Good," said I, "but as to those matters of politics; as to general
+differences of opinion in one and the same community. Do you assert
+that there are none?"
+
+"No, not at all," said he, somewhat snappishly; "but I do say that
+differences of opinion about real solid things need not, and with us
+do not, crystallise people into parties permanently hostile to one
+another, with different theories as to the build of the universe and
+the progress of time. Isn't that what politics used to mean?"
+
+"H'm, well," said I, "I am not so sure of that."
+
+Said he: "I take, you, neighbour; they only PRETENDED to this
+serious difference of opinion; for if it had existed they could not
+have dealt together in the ordinary business of life; couldn't have
+eaten together, bought and sold together, gambled together, cheated
+other people together, but must have fought whenever they met: which
+would not have suited them at all. The game of the masters of
+politics was to cajole or force the public to pay the expense of a
+luxurious life and exciting amusement for a few cliques of ambitious
+persons: and the PRETENCE of serious difference of opinion, belied
+by every action of their lives, was quite good enough for that. What
+has all that got to do with us?"
+
+Said I: "Why, nothing, I should hope. But I fear--In short, I have
+been told that political strife was a necessary result of human
+nature."
+
+"Human nature!" cried the old boy, impetuously; "what human nature?
+The human nature of paupers, of slaves, of slave-holders, or the
+human nature of wealthy freemen? Which? Come, tell me that!"
+
+"Well," said I, "I suppose there would be a difference according to
+circumstances in people's action about these matters."
+
+"I should think so, indeed," said he. "At all events, experience
+shows that it is so. Amongst us, our differences concern matters of
+business, and passing events as to them, and could not divide men
+permanently. As a rule, the immediate outcome shows which opinion on
+a given subject is the right one; it is a matter of fact, not of
+speculation. For instance, it is clearly not easy to knock up a
+political party on the question as to whether haymaking in such and
+such a country-side shall begin this week or next, when all men agree
+that it must at latest begin the week after next, and when any man
+can go down into the fields himself and see whether the seeds are
+ripe enough for the cutting."
+
+Said I: "And you settle these differences, great and small, by the
+will of the majority, I suppose?"
+
+"Certainly," said he; "how else could we settle them? You see in
+matters which are merely personal which do not affect the welfare of
+the community--how a man shall dress, what he shall eat and drink,
+what he shall write and read, and so forth--there can be no
+difference of opinion, and everybody does as he pleases. But when
+the matter is of common interest to the whole community, and the
+doing or not doing something affects everybody, the majority must
+have their way; unless the minority were to take up arms and show by
+force that they were the effective or real majority; which, however,
+in a society of men who are free and equal is little likely to
+happen; because in such a community the apparent majority IS the real
+majority, and the others, as I have hinted before, know that too well
+to obstruct from mere pigheadedness; especially as they have had
+plenty of opportunity of putting forward their side of the question."
+
+"How is that managed?" said I.
+
+"Well," said he, "let us take one of our units of management, a
+commune, or a ward, or a parish (for we have all three names,
+indicating little real distinction between them now, though time was
+there was a good deal). In such a district, as you would call it,
+some neighbours think that something ought to be done or undone: a
+new town-hall built; a clearance of inconvenient houses; or say a
+stone bridge substituted for some ugly old iron one,--there you have
+undoing and doing in one. Well, at the next ordinary meeting of the
+neighbours, or Mote, as we call it, according to the ancient tongue
+of the times before bureaucracy, a neighbour proposes the change, and
+of course, if everybody agrees, there is an end of discussion, except
+about details. Equally, if no one backs the proposer,--'seconds
+him,' it used to be called--the matter drops for the time being; a
+thing not likely to happen amongst reasonable men, however, as the
+proposer is sure to have talked it over with others before the Mote.
+But supposing the affair proposed and seconded, if a few of the
+neighbours disagree to it, if they think that the beastly iron bridge
+will serve a little longer and they don't want to be bothered with
+building a new one just then, they don't count heads that time, but
+put off the formal discussion to the next Mote; and meantime
+arguments pro and con are flying about, and some get printed, so that
+everybody knows what is going on; and when the Mote comes together
+again there is a regular discussion and at last a vote by show of
+hands. If the division is a close one, the question is again put off
+for further discussion; if the division is a wide one, the minority
+are asked if they will yield to the more general opinion, which they
+often, nay, most commonly do. If they refuse, the question is
+debated a third time, when, if the minority has not perceptibly
+grown, they always give way; though I believe there is some half-
+forgotten rule by which they might still carry it on further; but I
+say, what always happens is that they are convinced, not perhaps that
+their view is the wrong one, but they cannot persuade or force the
+community to adopt it."
+
+"Very good," said I; "but what happens if the divisions are still
+narrow?"
+
+Said he: "As a matter of principle and according to the rule of such
+cases, the question must then lapse, and the majority, if so narrow,
+has to submit to sitting down under the status quo. But I must tell
+you that in point of fact the minority very seldom enforces this
+rule, but generally yields in a friendly manner."
+
+"But do you know," said I, "that there is something in all this very
+like democracy; and I thought that democracy was considered to be in
+a moribund condition many, many years ago."
+
+The old boy's eyes twinkled. "I grant you that our methods have that
+drawback. But what is to be done? We can't get ANYONE amongst us to
+complain of his not always having his own way in the teeth of the
+community, when it is clear that EVERYBODY cannot have that
+indulgence. What is to be done?"
+
+"Well," said I, "I don't know."
+
+Said he: "The only alternatives to our method that I can conceive of
+are these. First, that we should choose out, or breed, a class of
+superior persons capable of judging on all matters without consulting
+the neighbours; that, in short, we should get for ourselves what used
+to be called an aristocracy of intellect; or, secondly, that for the
+purpose of safe-guarding the freedom of the individual will, we
+should revert to a system of private property again, and have slaves
+and slave-holders once more. What do you think of those two
+expedients?"
+
+"Well," said I, "there is a third possibility--to wit, that every man
+should be quite independent of every other, and that thus the tyranny
+of society should be abolished."
+
+He looked hard at me for a second or two, and then burst out laughing
+very heartily; and I confess that I joined him. When he recovered
+himself he nodded at me, and said: "Yes, yes, I quite agree with
+you--and so we all do."
+
+"Yes," I said, "and besides, it does not press hardly on the
+minority: for, take this matter of the bridge, no man is obliged to
+work on it if he doesn't agree to its building. At least, I suppose
+not."
+
+He smiled, and said: "Shrewdly put; and yet from the point of view
+of the native of another planet. If the man of the minority does
+find his feelings hurt, doubtless he may relieve them by refusing to
+help in building the bridge. But, dear neighbour, that is not a very
+effective salve for the wound caused by the 'tyranny of a majority'
+in our society; because all work that is done is either beneficial or
+hurtful to every member of society. The man is benefited by the
+bridge-building if it turns out a good thing, and hurt by it if it
+turns out a bad one, whether he puts a hand to it or not; and
+meanwhile he is benefiting the bridge-builders by his work, whatever
+that may be. In fact, I see no help for him except the pleasure of
+saying 'I told you so' if the bridge-building turns out to be a
+mistake and hurts him; if it benefits him he must suffer in silence.
+A terrible tyranny our Communism, is it not? Folk used often to be
+warned against this very unhappiness in times past, when for every
+well-fed, contented person you saw a thousand miserable starvelings.
+Whereas for us, we grow fat and well-liking on the tyranny; a
+tyranny, to say the truth, not to be made visible by any microscope I
+know. Don't be afraid, my friend; we are not going to seek for
+troubles by calling our peace and plenty and happiness by ill names
+whose very meaning we have forgotten!"
+
+He sat musing for a little, and then started and said: "Are there
+any more questions, dear guest? The morning is waning fast amidst my
+garrulity?'
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV: ON THE LACK OF INCENTIVE TO LABOUR IN A COMMUNIST
+SOCIETY
+
+
+
+"Yes," said I. "I was expecting Dick and Clara to make their
+appearance any moment: but is there time to ask just one or two
+questions before they come?"
+
+"Try it, dear neighbour--try it," said old Hammond. "For the more
+you ask me the better I am pleased; and at any rate if they do come
+and find me in the middle of an answer, they must sit quiet and
+pretend to listen till I come to an end. It won't hurt them; they
+will find it quite amusing enough to sit side by side, conscious of
+their proximity to each other."
+
+I smiled, as I was bound to, and said: "Good; I will go on talking
+without noticing them when they come in. Now, this is what I want to
+ask you about--to wit, how you get people to work when there is no
+reward of labour, and especially how you get them to work
+strenuously?"
+
+"No reward of labour?" said Hammond, gravely. "The reward of labour
+is LIFE. Is that not enough?"
+
+"But no reward for especially good work," quoth I.
+
+"Plenty of reward," said he--"the reward of creation. The wages
+which God gets, as people might have said time agone. If you are
+going to ask to be paid for the pleasure of creation, which is what
+excellence in work means, the next thing we shall hear of will be a
+bill sent in for the begetting of children."
+
+"Well, but," said I, "the man of the nineteenth century would say
+there is a natural desire towards the procreation of children, and a
+natural desire not to work."
+
+"Yes, yes," said he, "I know the ancient platitude,--wholly untrue;
+indeed, to us quite meaningless. Fourier, whom all men laughed at,
+understood the matter better."
+
+"Why is it meaningless to you?" said I.
+
+He said: "Because it implies that all work is suffering, and we are
+so far from thinking that, that, as you may have noticed, whereas we
+are not short of wealth, there is a kind of fear growing up amongst
+us that we shall one day be short of work. It is a pleasure which we
+are afraid of losing, not a pain."
+
+"Yes," said I, "I have noticed that, and I was going to ask you about
+that also. But in the meantime, what do you positively mean to
+assert about the pleasurableness of work amongst you?"
+
+"This, that ALL work is now pleasurable; either because of the hope
+of gain in honour and wealth with which the work is done, which
+causes pleasurable excitement, even when the actual work is not
+pleasant; or else because it has grown into a pleasurable HABIT, as
+in the case with what you may call mechanical work; and lastly (and
+most of our work is of this kind) because there is conscious sensuous
+pleasure in the work itself; it is done, that is, by artists."
+
+"I see," said I. "Can you now tell me how you have come to this
+happy condition? For, to speak plainly, this change from the
+conditions of the older world seems to me far greater and more
+important than all the other changes you have told me about as to
+crime, politics, property, marriage."
+
+"You are right there," said he. "Indeed, you may say rather that it
+is this change which makes all the others possible. What is the
+object of Revolution? Surely to make people happy. Revolution
+having brought its foredoomed change about, how can you prevent the
+counter-revolution from setting in except by making people happy?
+What! shall we expect peace and stability from unhappiness? The
+gathering of grapes from thorns and figs from thistles is a
+reasonable expectation compared with that! And happiness without
+happy daily work is impossible."
+
+"Most obviously true," said I: for I thought the old boy was
+preaching a little. "But answer my question, as to how you gained
+this happiness."
+
+"Briefly," said he, "by the absence of artificial coercion, and the
+freedom for every man to do what he can do best, joined to the
+knowledge of what productions of labour we really wanted. I must
+admit that this knowledge we reached slowly and painfully."
+
+"Go on," said I, "give me more detail; explain more fully. For this
+subject interests me intensely."
+
+"Yes, I will," said he; "but in order to do so I must weary you by
+talking a little about the past. Contrast is necessary for this
+explanation. Do you mind?"
+
+"No, no," said I.
+
+Said he, settling himself in his chair again for a long talk: "It is
+clear from all that we hear and read, that in the last age of
+civilisation men had got into a vicious circle in the matter of
+production of wares. They had reached a wonderful facility of
+production, and in order to make the most of that facility they had
+gradually created (or allowed to grow, rather) a most elaborate
+system of buying and selling, which has been called the World-Market;
+and that World-Market, once set a-going, forced them to go on making
+more and more of these wares, whether they needed them or not. So
+that while (of course) they could not free themselves from the toil
+of making real necessaries, they created in a never-ending series
+sham or artificial necessaries, which became, under the iron rule of
+the aforesaid World-Market, of equal importance to them with the real
+necessaries which supported life. By all this they burdened
+themselves with a prodigious mass of work merely for the sake of
+keeping their wretched system going."
+
+"Yes--and then?" said I.
+
+"Why, then, since they had forced themselves to stagger along under
+this horrible burden of unnecessary production, it became impossible
+for them to look upon labour and its results from any other point of
+view than one--to wit, the ceaseless endeavour to expend the least
+possible amount of labour on any article made, and yet at the same
+time to make as many articles as possible. To this 'cheapening of
+production', as it was called, everything was sacrificed: the
+happiness of the workman at his work, nay, his most elementary
+comfort and bare health, his food, his clothes, his dwelling, his
+leisure, his amusement, his education--his life, in short--did not
+weigh a grain of sand in the balance against this dire necessity of
+'cheap production' of things, a great part of which were not worth
+producing at all. Nay, we are told, and we must believe it, so
+overwhelming is the evidence, though many of our people scarcely CAN
+believe it, that even rich and powerful men, the masters of the poor
+devils aforesaid, submitted to live amidst sights and sounds and
+smells which it is in the very nature of man to abhor and flee from,
+in order that their riches might bolster up this supreme folly. The
+whole community, in fact, was cast into the jaws of this ravening
+monster, 'the cheap production' forced upon it by the World-Market."
+
+"Dear me!" said I. "But what happened? Did not their cleverness and
+facility in production master this chaos of misery at last? Couldn't
+they catch up with the World-Market, and then set to work to devise
+means for relieving themselves from this fearful task of extra
+labour?"
+
+He smiled bitterly. "Did they even try to?" said he. "I am not
+sure. You know that according to the old saw the beetle gets used to
+living in dung; and these people, whether they found the dung sweet
+or not, certainly lived in it."
+
+His estimate of the life of the nineteenth century made me catch my
+breath a little; and I said feebly, "But the labour-saving machines?"
+
+"Heyday!" quoth he. "What's that you are saying? the labour-saving
+machines? Yes, they were made to 'save labour' (or, to speak more
+plainly, the lives of men) on one piece of work in order that it
+might be expended--I will say wasted--on another, probably useless,
+piece of work. Friend, all their devices for cheapening labour
+simply resulted in increasing the burden of labour. The appetite of
+the World-Market grew with what it fed on: the countries within the
+ring of 'civilisation' (that is, organised misery) were glutted with
+the abortions of the market, and force and fraud were used
+unsparingly to 'open up' countries OUTSIDE that pale. This process
+of 'opening up' is a strange one to those who have read the
+professions of the men of that period and do not understand their
+practice; and perhaps shows us at its worst the great vice of the
+nineteenth century, the use of hypocrisy and cant to evade the
+responsibility of vicarious ferocity. When the civilised World-
+Market coveted a country not yet in its clutches, some transparent
+pretext was found--the suppression of a slavery different from and
+not so cruel as that of commerce; the pushing of a religion no longer
+believed in by its promoters; the 'rescue' of some desperado or
+homicidal madman whose misdeeds had got him into trouble amongst the
+natives of the 'barbarous' country--any stick, in short, which would
+beat the dog at all. Then some bold, unprincipled, ignorant
+adventurer was found (no difficult task in the days of competition),
+and he was bribed to 'create a market' by breaking up whatever
+traditional society there might be in the doomed country, and by
+destroying whatever leisure or pleasure he found there. He forced
+wares on the natives which they did not want, and took their natural
+products in 'exchange,' as this form of robbery was called, and
+thereby he 'created new wants,' to supply which (that is, to be
+allowed to live by their new masters) the hapless, helpless people
+had to sell themselves into the slavery of hopeless toil so that they
+might have something wherewith to purchase the nullities of
+'civilisation.' Ah," said the old man, pointing the dealings of to
+the Museum, "I have read books and papers in there, telling strange
+stories indeed of civilisation (or organised misery) with 'non-
+civilisation'; from the time when the British Government deliberately
+sent blankets infected with small-pox as choice gifts to inconvenient
+tribes of Red-skins, to the time when Africa was infested by a man
+named Stanley, who--"
+
+"Excuse me," said I, "but as you know, time presses; and I want to
+keep our question on the straightest line possible; and I want at
+once to ask this about these wares made for the World-Market--how
+about their quality; these people who were so clever about making
+goods, I suppose they made them well?"
+
+"Quality!" said the old man crustily, for he was rather peevish at
+being cut short in his story; "how could they possibly attend to such
+trifles as the quality of the wares they sold? The best of them were
+of a lowish average, the worst were transparent make-shifts for the
+things asked for, which nobody would have put up with if they could
+have got anything else. It was a current jest of the time that the
+wares were made to sell and not to use; a jest which you, as coming
+from another planet, may understand, but which our folk could not."
+
+Said I: "What! did they make nothing well?"
+
+"Why, yes," said he, "there was one class of goods which they did
+make thoroughly well, and that was the class of machines which were
+used for making things. These were usually quite perfect pieces of
+workmanship, admirably adapted to the end in view. So that it may be
+fairly said that the great achievement of the nineteenth century was
+the making of machines which were wonders of invention, skill, and
+patience, and which were used for the production of measureless
+quantities of worthless make-shifts. In truth, the owners of the
+machines did not consider anything which they made as wares, but
+simply as means for the enrichment of themselves. Of course the only
+admitted test of utility in wares was the finding of buyers for them-
+-wise men or fools, as it might chance."
+
+"And people put up with this?" said I.
+
+"For a time," said he.
+
+"And then?"
+
+"And then the overturn," said the old man, smiling, "and the
+nineteenth century saw itself as a man who has lost his clothes
+whilst bathing, and has to walk naked through the town."
+
+"You are very bitter about that unlucky nineteenth century," said I.
+
+"Naturally," said he, "since I know so much about it."
+
+He was silent a little, and then said: "There are traditions--nay,
+real histories--in our family about it: my grandfather was one of
+its victims. If you know something about it, you will understand
+what he suffered when I tell you that he was in those days a genuine
+artist, a man of genius, and a revolutionist."
+
+"I think I do understand," said I: "but now, as it seems, you have
+reversed all this?"
+
+"Pretty much so," said he. "The wares which we make are made because
+they are needed: men make for their neighbours' use as if they were
+making for themselves, not for a vague market of which they know
+nothing, and over which they have no control: as there is no buying
+and selling, it would be mere insanity to make goods on the chance of
+their being wanted; for there is no longer anyone who can be
+compelled to buy them. So that whatever is made is good, and
+thoroughly fit for its purpose. Nothing can be made except for
+genuine use; therefore no inferior goods are made. Moreover, as
+aforesaid, we have now found out what we want, so we make no more
+than we want; and as we are not driven to make a vast quantity of
+useless things we have time and resources enough to consider our
+pleasure in making them. All work which would be irksome to do by
+hand is done by immensely improved machinery; and in all work which
+it is a pleasure to do by hand machinery is done without. There is
+no difficulty in finding work which suits the special turn of mind of
+everybody; so that no man is sacrificed to the wants of another.
+From time to time, when we have found out that some piece of work was
+too disagreeable or troublesome, we have given it up and done
+altogether without the thing produced by it. Now, surely you can see
+that under these circumstances all the work that we do is an exercise
+of the mind and body more or less pleasant to be done: so that
+instead of avoiding work everybody seeks it: and, since people have
+got defter in doing the work generation after generation, it has
+become so easy to do, that it seems as if there were less done,
+though probably more is produced. I suppose this explains that fear,
+which I hinted at just now, of a possible scarcity in work, which
+perhaps you have already noticed, and which is a feeling on the
+increase, and has been for a score of years."
+
+"But do you think," said I, "that there is any fear of a work-famine
+amongst you?"
+
+"No, I do not," said he, "and I will tell why; it is each man's
+business to make his own work pleasanter and pleasanter, which of
+course tends towards raising the standard of excellence, as no man
+enjoys turning out work which is not a credit to him, and also to
+greater deliberation in turning it out; and there is such a vast
+number of things which can be treated as works of art, that this
+alone gives employment to a host of deft people. Again, if art be
+inexhaustible, so is science also; and though it is no longer the
+only innocent occupation which is thought worth an intelligent man
+spending his time upon, as it once was, yet there are, and I suppose
+will be, many people who are excited by its conquest of difficulties,
+and care for it more than for anything else. Again, as more and more
+of pleasure is imported into work, I think we shall take up kinds of
+work which produce desirable wares, but which we gave up because we
+could not carry them on pleasantly. Moreover, I think that it is
+only in parts of Europe which are more advanced than the rest of the
+world that you will hear this talk of the fear of a work-famine.
+Those lands which were once the colonies of Great Britain, for
+instance, and especially America--that part of it, above all, which
+was once the United states--are now and will be for a long while a
+great resource to us. For these lands, and, I say, especially the
+northern parts of America, suffered so terribly from the full force
+of the last days of civilisation, and became such horrible places to
+live in, that they are now very backward in all that makes life
+pleasant. Indeed, one may say that for nearly a hundred years the
+people of the northern parts of America have been engaged in
+gradually making a dwelling-place out of a stinking dust-heap; and
+there is still a great deal to do, especially as the country is so
+big."
+
+"Well," said I, "I am exceedingly glad to think that you have such a
+prospect of happiness before you. But I should like to ask a few
+more questions, and then I have done for to-day."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI: DINNER IN THE HALL OF THE BLOOMSBURY MARKET
+
+
+
+As I spoke, I heard footsteps near the door; the latch yielded, and
+in came our two lovers, looking so handsome that one had no feeling
+of shame in looking on at their little-concealed love-making; for
+indeed it seemed as if all the world must be in love with them. As
+for old Hammond, he looked on them like an artist who has just
+painted a picture nearly as well as he thought he could when he began
+it, and was perfectly happy. He said:
+
+"Sit down, sit down, young folk, and don't make a noise. Our guest
+here has still some questions to ask me."
+
+"Well, I should suppose so," said Dick; "you have only been three
+hours and a half together; and it isn't to be hoped that the history
+of two centuries could be told in three hours and a half: let alone
+that, for all I know, you may have been wandering into the realms of
+geography and craftsmanship."
+
+"As to noise, my dear kinsman," said Clara, "you will very soon be
+disturbed by the noise of the dinner-bell, which I should think will
+be very pleasant music to our guest, who breakfasted early, it seems,
+and probably had a tiring day yesterday."
+
+I said: "Well, since you have spoken the word, I begin to feel that
+it is so; but I have been feeding myself with wonder this long time
+past: really, it's quite true," quoth I, as I saw her smile, O so
+prettily! But just then from some tower high up in the air came the
+sound of silvery chimes playing a sweet clear tune, that sounded to
+my unaccustomed ears like the song of the first blackbird in the
+spring, and called a rush of memories to my mind, some of bad times,
+some of good, but all sweetened now into mere pleasure.
+
+"No more questions now before dinner," said Clara; and she took my
+hand as an affectionate child would, and led me out of the room and
+down stairs into the forecourt of the Museum, leaving the two
+Hammonds to follow as they pleased.
+
+We went into the market-place which I had been in before, a thinnish
+stream of elegantly {1} dressed people going in along with us. We
+turned into the cloister and came to a richly moulded and carved
+doorway, where a very pretty dark-haired young girl gave us each a
+beautiful bunch of summer flowers, and we entered a hall much bigger
+than that of the Hammersmith Guest House, more elaborate in its
+architecture and perhaps more beautiful. I found it difficult to
+keep my eyes off the wall-pictures (for I thought it bad manners to
+stare at Clara all the time, though she was quite worth it). I saw
+at a glance that their subjects were taken from queer old-world myths
+and imaginations which in yesterday's world only about half a dozen
+people in the country knew anything about; and when the two Hammonds
+sat down opposite to us, I said to the old man, pointing to the
+frieze:
+
+"How strange to see such subjects here!"
+
+"Why?" said he. "I don't see why you should be surprised; everybody
+knows the tales; and they are graceful and pleasant subjects, not too
+tragic for a place where people mostly eat and drink and amuse
+themselves, and yet full of incident."
+
+I smiled, and said: "Well, I scarcely expected to find record of the
+Seven Swans and the King of the Golden Mountain and Faithful Henry,
+and such curious pleasant imaginations as Jacob Grimm got together
+from the childhood of the world, barely lingering even in his time:
+I should have thought you would have forgotten such childishness by
+this time."
+
+The old man smiled, and said nothing; but Dick turned rather red, and
+broke out:
+
+"What DO you mean, guest? I think them very beautiful, I mean not
+only the pictures, but the stories; and when we were children we used
+to imagine them going on in every wood-end, by the bight of every
+stream: every house in the fields was the Fairyland King's House to
+us. Don't you remember, Clara?"
+
+"Yes," she said; and it seemed to me as if a slight cloud came over
+her fair face. I was going to speak to her on the subject, when the
+pretty waitresses came to us smiling, and chattering sweetly like
+reed warblers by the river side, and fell to giving us our dinner.
+As to this, as at our breakfast, everything was cooked and served
+with a daintiness which showed that those who had prepared it were
+interested in it; but there was no excess either of quantity or of
+gourmandise; everything was simple, though so excellent of its kind;
+and it was made clear to us that this was no feast, only an ordinary
+meal. The glass, crockery, and plate were very beautiful to my eyes,
+used to the study of mediaeval art; but a nineteenth-century club-
+haunter would, I daresay, have found them rough and lacking in
+finish; the crockery being lead-glazed pot-ware, though beautifully
+ornamented; the only porcelain being here and there a piece of old
+oriental ware. The glass, again, though elegant and quaint, and very
+varied in form, was somewhat bubbled and hornier in texture than the
+commercial articles of the nineteenth century. The furniture and
+general fittings of the ball were much of a piece with the table-
+gear, beautiful in form and highly ornamented, but without the
+commercial "finish" of the joiners and cabinet-makers of our time.
+Withal, there was a total absence of what the nineteenth century
+calls "comfort"--that is, stuffy inconvenience; so that, even apart
+from the delightful excitement of the day, I had never eaten my
+dinner so pleasantly before.
+
+When we had done eating, and were sitting a little while, with a
+bottle of very good Bordeaux wine before us, Clara came back to the
+question of the subject-matter of the pictures, as though it had
+troubled her.
+
+She looked up at them, and said: "How is it that though we are so
+interested with our life for the most part, yet when people take to
+writing poems or painting pictures they seldom deal with our modern
+life, or if they do, take good care to make their poems or pictures
+unlike that life? Are we not good enough to paint ourselves? How is
+it that we find the dreadful times of the past so interesting to us--
+in pictures and poetry?"
+
+Old Hammond smiled. "It always was so, and I suppose always will
+be," said he, "however it may be explained. It is true that in the
+nineteenth century, when there was so little art and so much talk
+about it, there was a theory that art and imaginative literature
+ought to deal with contemporary life; but they never did so; for, if
+there was any pretence of it, the author always took care (as Clara
+hinted just now) to disguise, or exaggerate, or idealise, and in some
+way or another make it strange; so that, for all the verisimilitude
+there was, he might just as well have dealt with the times of the
+Pharaohs."
+
+"Well," said Dick, "surely it is but natural to like these things
+strange; just as when we were children, as I said just now, we used
+to pretend to be so-and-so in such-and-such a place. That's what
+these pictures and poems do; and why shouldn't they?"
+
+"Thou hast hit it, Dick," quoth old Hammond; "it is the child-like
+part of us that produces works of imagination. When we are children
+time passes so slow with us that we seem to have time for
+everything."
+
+He sighed, and then smiled and said: "At least let us rejoice that
+we have got back our childhood again. I drink to the days that are!"
+
+"Second childhood," said I in a low voice, and then blushed at my
+double rudeness, and hoped that he hadn't heard. But he had, and
+turned to me smiling, and said: "Yes, why not? And for my part, I
+hope it may last long; and that the world's next period of wise and
+unhappy manhood, if that should happen, will speedily lead us to a
+third childhood: if indeed this age be not our third. Meantime, my
+friend, you must know that we are too happy, both individually and
+collectively, to trouble ourselves about what is to come hereafter."
+
+"Well, for my part," said Clara, "I wish we were interesting enough
+to be written or painted about."
+
+Dick answered her with some lover's speech, impossible to be written
+down, and then we sat quiet a little.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII: HOW THE CHANGE CAME
+
+
+
+Dick broke the silence at last, saying: "Guest, forgive us for a
+little after-dinner dulness. What would you like to do? Shall we
+have out Greylocks and trot back to Hammersmith? or will you come
+with us and hear some Welsh folk sing in a hall close by here? or
+would you like presently to come with me into the City and see some
+really fine building? or--what shall it be?"
+
+"Well," said I, "as I am a stranger, I must let you choose for me."
+
+In point of fact, I did not by any means want to be 'amused' just
+then; and also I rather felt as if the old man, with his knowledge of
+past times, and even a kind of inverted sympathy for them caused by
+his active hatred of them, was as it were a blanket for me against
+the cold of this very new world, where I was, so to say, stripped
+bare of every habitual thought and way of acting; and I did not want
+to leave him too soon. He came to my rescue at once, and said -
+
+"Wait a bit, Dick; there is someone else to be consulted besides you
+and the guest here, and that is I. I am not going to lose the
+pleasure of his company just now, especially as I know he has
+something else to ask me. So go to your Welshmen, by all means; but
+first of all bring us another bottle of wine to this nook, and then
+be off as soon as you like; and come again and fetch our friend to go
+westward, but not too soon."
+
+Dick nodded smilingly, and the old man and I were soon alone in the
+great hall, the afternoon sun gleaming on the red wine in our tall
+quaint-shaped glasses. Then said Hammond:
+
+"Does anything especially puzzle you about our way of living, now you
+have heard a good deal and seen a little of it?"
+
+Said I: "I think what puzzles me most is how it all came about."
+
+"It well may," said he, "so great as the change is. It would be
+difficult indeed to tell you the whole story, perhaps impossible:
+knowledge, discontent, treachery, disappointment, ruin, misery,
+despair--those who worked for the change because they could see
+further than other people went through all these phases of suffering;
+and doubtless all the time the most of men looked on, not knowing
+what was doing, thinking it all a matter of course, like the rising
+and setting of the sun--and indeed it was so."
+
+"Tell me one thing, if you can," said I. "Did the change, the
+'revolution' it used to be called, come peacefully?"
+
+"Peacefully?" said he; "what peace was there amongst those poor
+confused wretches of the nineteenth century? It was war from
+beginning to end: bitter war, till hope and pleasure put an end to
+it."
+
+"Do you mean actual fighting with weapons?" said I, "or the strikes
+and lock-outs and starvation of which we have heard?"
+
+"Both, both," he said. "As a matter of fact, the history of the
+terrible period of transition from commercial slavery to freedom may
+thus be summarised. When the hope of realising a communal condition
+of life for all men arose, quite late in the nineteenth century, the
+power of the middle classes, the then tyrants of society, was so
+enormous and crushing, that to almost all men, even those who had,
+you may say despite themselves, despite their reason and judgment,
+conceived such hopes, it seemed a dream. So much was this the case
+that some of those more enlightened men who were then called
+Socialists, although they well knew, and even stated in public, that
+the only reasonable condition of Society was that of pure Communism
+(such as you now see around you), yet shrunk from what seemed to them
+the barren task of preaching the realisation of a happy dream.
+Looking back now, we can see that the great motive-power of the
+change was a longing for freedom and equality, akin if you please to
+the unreasonable passion of the lover; a sickness of heart that
+rejected with loathing the aimless solitary life of the well-to-do
+educated man of that time: phrases, my dear friend, which have lost
+their meaning to us of the present day; so far removed we are from
+the dreadful facts which they represent.
+
+"Well, these men, though conscious of this feeling, had no faith in
+it, as a means of bringing about the change. Nor was that wonderful:
+for looking around them they saw the huge mass of the oppressed
+classes too much burdened with the misery of their lives, and too
+much overwhelmed by the selfishness of misery, to be able to form a
+conception of any escape from it except by the ordinary way
+prescribed by the system of slavery under which they lived; which was
+nothing more than a remote chance of climbing out of the oppressed
+into the oppressing class.
+
+"Therefore, though they knew that the only reasonable aim for those
+who would better the world was a condition of equality; in their
+impatience and despair they managed to convince themselves that if
+they could by hook or by crook get the machinery of production and
+the management of property so altered that the 'lower classes' (so
+the horrible word ran) might have their slavery somewhat ameliorated,
+they would be ready to fit into this machinery, and would use it for
+bettering their condition still more and still more, until at last
+the result would be a practical equality (they were very fond of
+using the word 'practical'), because 'the rich' would be forced to
+pay so much for keeping 'the poor' in a tolerable condition that the
+condition of riches would become no longer valuable and would
+gradually die out. Do you follow me?"
+
+"Partly," said I. "Go on."
+
+Said old Hammond: "Well, since you follow me, you will see that as a
+theory this was not altogether unreasonable; but 'practically,' it
+turned out a failure."
+
+"How so?" said I.
+
+"Well, don't you see," said he, "because it involved the making of a
+machinery by those who didn't know what they wanted the machines to
+do. So far as the masses of the oppressed class furthered this
+scheme of improvement, they did it to get themselves improved slave-
+rations--as many of them as could. And if those classes had really
+been incapable of being touched by that instinct which produced the
+passion for freedom and equality aforesaid, what would have happened,
+I think, would have been this: that a certain part of the working
+classes would have been so far improved in condition that they would
+have approached the condition of the middling rich men; but below
+them would have been a great class of most miserable slaves, whose
+slavery would have been far more hopeless than the older class-
+slavery had been."
+
+"What stood in the way of this?" said I.
+
+"'Why, of course," said he, "just that instinct for freedom
+aforesaid. It is true that the slave-class could not conceive the
+happiness of a free life. Yet they grew to understand (and very
+speedily too) that they were oppressed by their masters, and they
+assumed, you see how justly, that they could do without them, though
+perhaps they scarce knew how; so that it came to this, that though
+they could not look forward to the happiness or peace of the freeman,
+they did at least look forward to the war which a vague hope told
+them would bring that peace about."
+
+"Could you tell me rather more closely what actually took place?"
+said I; for I thought HIM rather vague here.
+
+"Yes," he said, "I can. That machinery of life for the use of people
+who didn't know what they wanted of it, and which was known at the
+time as State Socialism, was partly put in motion, though in a very
+piecemeal way. But it did not work smoothly; it was, of course,
+resisted at every turn by the capitalists; and no wonder, for it
+tended more and more to upset the commercial system I have told you
+of; without providing anything really effective in its place. The
+result was growing confusion, great suffering amongst the working
+classes, and, as a consequence, great discontent. For a long time
+matters went on like this. The power of the upper classes had
+lessened, as their command over wealth lessened, and they could not
+carry things wholly by the high hand as they had been used to in
+earlier days. So far the State Socialists were justified by the
+result. On the other hand, the working classes were ill-organised,
+and growing poorer in reality, in spite of the gains (also real in
+the long run) which they had forced from the masters. Thus matters
+hung in the balance; the masters could not reduce their slaves to
+complete subjection, though they put down some feeble and partial
+riots easily enough. The workers forced their masters to grant them
+ameliorations, real or imaginary, of their condition, but could not
+force freedom from them. At last came a great crash. To explain
+this you must understand that very great progress had been made
+amongst the workers, though as before said but little in the
+direction of improved livelihood."
+
+I played the innocent and said: "In what direction could they
+improve, if not in livelihood?"
+
+Said he: "In the power to bring about a state of things in which
+livelihood would be full, and easy to gain. They had at last learned
+how to combine after a long period of mistakes and disasters. The
+workmen had now a regular organization in the struggle against their
+masters, a struggle which for more than half a century had been
+accepted as an inevitable part of the conditions of the modern system
+of labour and production. This combination had now taken the form of
+a federation of all or almost all the recognised wage-paid
+employments, and it was by its means that those betterments of the
+conditions of the workmen had been forced from the masters: and
+though they were not seldom mixed up with the rioting that happened,
+especially in the earlier days of their organization, it by no means
+formed an essential part of their tactics; indeed at the time I am
+now speaking of they had got to be so strong that most commonly the
+mere threat of a 'strike' was enough to gain any minor point:
+because they had given up the foolish tactics of the ancient trades
+unions of calling out of work a part only of the workers of such and
+such an industry, and supporting them while out of work on the labour
+of those that remained in. By this time they had a biggish fund of
+money for the support of strikes, and could stop a certain industry
+altogether for a time if they so determined."
+
+Said I: "Was there not a serious danger of such moneys being
+misused--of jobbery, in fact?"
+
+Old Hammond wriggled uneasily on his seat, and said:
+
+"Though all this happened so long ago, I still feel the pain of mere
+shame when I have to tell you that it was more than a danger: that
+such rascality often happened; indeed more than once the whole
+combination seemed dropping to pieces because of it: but at the time
+of which I am telling, things looked so threatening, and to the
+workmen at least the necessity of their dealing with the fast-
+gathering trouble which the labour-struggle had brought about, was so
+clear, that the conditions of the times had begot a deep seriousness
+amongst all reasonable people; a determination which put aside all
+non-essentials, and which to thinking men was ominous of the swiftly-
+approaching change: such an element was too dangerous for mere
+traitors and self-seekers, and one by one they were thrust out and
+mostly joined the declared reactionaries."
+
+"How about those ameliorations," said I; "what were they? or rather
+of what nature?"
+
+Said he: "Some of them, and these of the most practical importance
+to the mens' livelihood, were yielded by the masters by direct
+compulsion on the part of the men; the new conditions of labour so
+gained were indeed only customary, enforced by no law: but, once
+established, the masters durst not attempt to withdraw them in face
+of the growing power of the combined workers. Some again were steps
+on the path of 'State Socialism'; the most important of which can be
+speedily summed up. At the end of the nineteenth century the cry
+arose for compelling the masters to employ their men a less number of
+hours in the day: this cry gathered volume quickly, and the masters
+had to yield to it. But it was, of course, clear that unless this
+meant a higher price for work per hour, it would be a mere nullity,
+and that the masters, unless forced, would reduce it to that.
+Therefore after a long struggle another law was passed fixing a
+minimum price for labour in the most important industries; which
+again had to be supplemented by a law fixing the maximum price on the
+chief wares then considered necessary for a workman's life."
+
+"You were getting perilously near to the late Roman poor-rates," said
+I, smiling, "and the doling out of bread to the proletariat."
+
+"So many said at the time," said the old man drily; "and it has long
+been a commonplace that that slough awaits State Socialism in the
+end, if it gets to the end, which as you know it did not with us.
+However it went further than this minimum and maximum business, which
+by the by we can now see was necessary. The government now found it
+imperative on them to meet the outcry of the master class at the
+approaching destruction of Commerce (as desirable, had they known it,
+as the extinction of the cholera, which has since happily taken
+place). And they were forced to meet it by a measure hostile to the
+masters, the establishment of government factories for the production
+of necessary wares, and markets for their sale. These measures taken
+altogether did do something: they were in fact of the nature of
+regulations made by the commander of a beleaguered city. But of
+course to the privileged classes it seemed as if the end of the world
+were come when such laws were enacted.
+
+"Nor was that altogether without a warrant: the spread of
+communistic theories, and the partial practice of State Socialism had
+at first disturbed, and at last almost paralysed the marvellous
+system of commerce under which the old world had lived so feverishly,
+and had produced for some few a life of gambler's pleasure, and for
+many, or most, a life of mere misery: over and over again came 'bad
+times' as they were called, and indeed they were bad enough for the
+wage-slaves. The year 1952 was one of the worst of these times; the
+workmen suffered dreadfully: the partial, inefficient government
+factories, which were terribly jobbed, all but broke down, and a vast
+part of the population had for the time being to be fed on
+undisguised "charity" as it was called.
+
+"The Combined Workers watched the situation with mingled hope and
+anxiety. They had already formulated their general demands; but now
+by a solemn and universal vote of the whole of their federated
+societies, they insisted on the first step being taken toward
+carrying out their demands: this step would have led directly to
+handing over the management of the whole natural resources of the
+country, together with the machinery for using them into the power of
+the Combined Workers, and the reduction of the privileged classes
+into the position of pensioners obviously dependent on the pleasure
+of the workers. The 'Resolution,' as it was called, which was widely
+published in the newspapers of the day, was in fact a declaration of
+war, and was so accepted by the master class. They began
+henceforward to prepare for a firm stand against the 'brutal and
+ferocious communism of the day,' as they phrased it. And as they
+were in many ways still very powerful, or seemed so to be; they still
+hoped by means of brute force to regain some of what they had lost,
+and perhaps in the end the whole of it. It was said amongst them on
+all hands that it had been a great mistake of the various governments
+not to have resisted sooner; and the liberals and radicals (the name
+as perhaps you may know of the more democratically inclined part of
+the ruling classes) were much blamed for having led the world to this
+pass by their mis-timed pedantry and foolish sentimentality: and one
+Gladstone, or Gledstein (probably, judging by this name, of
+Scandinavian descent), a notable politician of the nineteenth
+century, was especially singled out for reprobation in this respect.
+I need scarcely point out to you the absurdity of all this. But
+terrible tragedy lay hidden behind this grinning through a horse-
+collar of the reactionary party. 'The insatiable greed of the lower
+classes must be repressed'--'The people must be taught a lesson'--
+these were the sacramental phrases current amongst the reactionists,
+and ominous enough they were."
+
+The old man stopped to look keenly at my attentive and wondering
+face; and then said:
+
+"I know, dear guest, that I have been using words and phrases which
+few people amongst us could understand without long and laborious
+explanation; and not even then perhaps. But since you have not yet
+gone to sleep, and since I am speaking to you as to a being from
+another planet, I may venture to ask you if you have followed me thus
+far?"
+
+"O yes," said I, "I quite understand: pray go on; a great deal of
+what you have been saying was common place with us--when--when--"
+
+"Yes," said he gravely, "when you were dwelling in the other planet.
+Well, now for the crash aforesaid.
+
+"On some comparatively trifling occasion a great meeting was summoned
+by the workmen leaders to meet in Trafalgar Square (about the right
+to meet in which place there had for years and years been bickering).
+The civic bourgeois guard (called the police) attacked the said
+meeting with bludgeons, according to their custom; many people were
+hurt in the melee, of whom five in all died, either trampled to death
+on the spot, or from the effects of their cudgelling; the meeting was
+scattered, and some hundred of prisoners cast into gaol. A similar
+meeting had been treated in the same way a few days before at a place
+called Manchester, which has now disappeared. Thus the 'lesson'
+began. The whole country was thrown into a ferment by this; meetings
+were held which attempted some rough organisation for the holding of
+another meeting to retort on the authorities. A huge crowd assembled
+in Trafalgar Square and the neighbourhood (then a place of crowded
+streets), and was too big for the bludgeon-armed police to cope with;
+there was a good deal of dry-blow fighting; three or four of the
+people were killed, and half a score of policemen were crushed to
+death in the throng, and the rest got away as they could. This was a
+victory for the people as far as it went. The next day all London
+(remember what it was in those days) was in a state of turmoil. Many
+of the rich fled into the country; the executive got together
+soldiery, but did not dare to use them; and the police could not be
+massed in any one place, because riots or threats of riots were
+everywhere. But in Manchester, where the people were not so
+courageous or not so desperate as in London, several of the popular
+leaders were arrested. In London a convention of leaders was got
+together from the Federation of Combined Workmen, and sat under the
+old revolutionary name of the Committee of Public Safety; but as they
+had no drilled and armed body of men to direct, they attempted no
+aggressive measures, but only placarded the walls with somewhat vague
+appeals to the workmen not to allow themselves to be trampled upon.
+However, they called a meeting in Trafalgar Square for the day
+fortnight of the last-mentioned skirmish.
+
+"Meantime the town grew no quieter, and business came pretty much to
+an end. The newspapers--then, as always hitherto, almost entirely in
+the hands of the masters--clamoured to the Government for repressive
+measures; the rich citizens were enrolled as an extra body of police,
+and armed with bludgeons like them; many of these were strong, well-
+fed, full-blooded young men, and had plenty of stomach for fighting;
+but the Government did not dare to use them, and contented itself
+with getting full powers voted to it by the Parliament for
+suppressing any revolt, and bringing up more and more soldiers to
+London. Thus passed the week after the great meeting; almost as
+large a one was held on the Sunday, which went off peaceably on the
+whole, as no opposition to it was offered, and again the people cried
+'victory.' But on the Monday the people woke up to find that they
+were hungry. During the last few days there had been groups of men
+parading the streets asking (or, if you please, demanding) money to
+buy food; and what for goodwill, what for fear, the richer people
+gave them a good deal. The authorities of the parishes also (I
+haven't time to explain that phrase at present) gave willy-nilly what
+provisions they could to wandering people; and the Government, by
+means of its feeble national workshops, also fed a good number of
+half-starved folk. But in addition to this, several bakers' shops
+and other provision stores had been emptied without a great deal of
+disturbance. So far, so good. But on the Monday in question the
+Committee of Public Safety, on the one hand afraid of general
+unorganised pillage, and on the other emboldened by the wavering
+conduct of the authorities, sent a deputation provided with carts and
+all necessary gear to clear out two or three big provision stores in
+the centre of the town, leaving papers with the shop managers
+promising to pay the price of them: and also in the part of the town
+where they were strongest they took possession of several bakers'
+shops and set men at work in them for the benefit of the people;--all
+of which was done with little or no disturbance, the police assisting
+in keeping order at the sack of the stores, as they would have done
+at a big fire.
+
+"But at this last stroke the reactionaries were so alarmed, that they
+were, determined to force the executive into action. The newspapers
+next day all blazed into the fury of frightened people, and
+threatened the people, the Government, and everybody they could think
+of, unless 'order were at once restored.' A deputation of leading
+commercial people waited on the Government and told them that if they
+did not at once arrest the Committee of Public Safety, they
+themselves would gather a body of men, arm them, and fall on 'the
+incendiaries,' as they called them.
+
+"They, together with a number of the newspaper editors, had a long
+interview with the heads of the Government and two or three military
+men, the deftest in their art that the country could furnish. The
+deputation came away from that interview, says a contemporary eye-
+witness, smiling and satisfied, and said no more about raising an
+anti-popular army, but that afternoon left London with their families
+for their country seats or elsewhere.
+
+"The next morning the Government proclaimed a state of siege in
+London,--a thing common enough amongst the absolutist governments on
+the Continent, but unheard-of in England in those days. They
+appointed the youngest and cleverest of their generals to command the
+proclaimed district; a man who had won a certain sort of reputation
+in the disgraceful wars in which the country had been long engaged
+from time to time. The newspapers were in ecstacies, and all the
+most fervent of the reactionaries now came to the front; men who in
+ordinary times were forced to keep their opinions to themselves or
+their immediate circle, but who began to look forward to crushing
+once for all the Socialist, and even democratic tendencies, which,
+said they, had been treated with such foolish indulgence for the last
+sixty years.
+
+"But the clever general took no visible action; and yet only a few of
+the minor newspapers abused him; thoughtful men gathered from this
+that a plot was hatching. As for the Committee of Public Safety,
+whatever they thought of their position, they had now gone too far to
+draw back; and many of them, it seems, thought that the government
+would not act. They went on quietly organising their food supply,
+which was a miserable driblet when all is said; and also as a retort
+to the state of siege, they armed as many men as they could in the
+quarter where they were strongest, but did not attempt to drill or
+organise them, thinking, perhaps, that they could not at the best
+turn them into trained soldiers till they had some breathing space.
+The clever general, his soldiers, and the police did not meddle with
+all this in the least in the world; and things were quieter in London
+that week-end; though there were riots in many places of the
+provinces, which were quelled by the authorities without much
+trouble. The most serious of these were at Glasgow and Bristol.
+
+"Well, the Sunday of the meeting came, and great crowds came to
+Trafalgar Square in procession, the greater part of the Committee
+amongst them, surrounded by their band of men armed somehow or other.
+The streets were quite peaceful and quiet, though there were many
+spectators to see the procession pass. Trafalgar Square had no body
+of police in it; the people took quiet possession of it, and the
+meeting began. The armed men stood round the principal platform, and
+there were a few others armed amidst the general crowd; but by far
+the greater part were unarmed.
+
+"Most people thought the meeting would go off peaceably; but the
+members of the Committee had heard from various quarters that
+something would be attempted against them; but these rumours were
+vague, and they had no idea of what threatened. They soon found out.
+
+"For before the streets about the Square were filled, a body of
+soldiers poured into it from the north-west corner and took up their
+places by the houses that stood on the west side. The people growled
+at the sight of the red-coats; the armed men of the Committee stood
+undecided, not knowing what to do; and indeed this new influx so
+jammed the crowd together that, unorganised as they were, they had
+little chance of working through it. They had scarcely grasped the
+fact of their enemies being there, when another column of soldiers,
+pouring out of the streets which led into the great southern road
+going down to the Parliament House (still existing, and called the
+Dung Market), and also from the embankment by the side of the Thames,
+marched up, pushing the crowd into a denser and denser mass, and
+formed along the south side of the Square. Then any of those who
+could see what was going on, knew at once that they were in a trap,
+and could only wonder what would be done with them.
+
+"The closely-packed crowd would not or could not budge, except under
+the influence of the height of terror, which was soon to be supplied
+to them. A few of the armed men struggled to the front, or climbled
+up to the base of the monument which then stood there, that they
+might face the wall of hidden fire before them; and to most men
+(there were many women amongst them) it seemed as if the end of the
+world had come, and to-day seemed strangely different from yesterday.
+No sooner were the soldiers drawn up aforesaid than, says an eye-
+witness, 'a glittering officer on horseback came prancing out from
+the ranks on the south, and read something from a paper which he held
+in his hand; which something, very few heard; but I was told
+afterwards that it was an order for us to disperse, and a warning
+that he had legal right to fire on the crowd else, and that he would
+do so. The crowd took it as a challenge of some sort, and a hoarse
+threatening roar went up from them; and after that there was
+comparative silence for a little, till the officer had got back into
+the ranks. I was near the edge of the crowd, towards the soldiers,'
+says this eye-witness, 'and I saw three little machines being wheeled
+out in front of the ranks, which I knew for mechanical guns. I cried
+out, "Throw yourselves down! they are going to fire!" But no one
+scarcely could throw himself down, so tight as the crowd were packed.
+I heard a sharp order given, and wondered where I should be the next
+minute; and then--It was as if--the earth had opened, and hell had
+come up bodily amidst us. It is no use trying to describe the scene
+that followed. Deep lanes were mowed amidst the thick crowd; the
+dead and dying covered the ground, and the shrieks and wails and
+cries of horror filled all the air, till it seemed as if there were
+nothing else in the world but murder and death. Those of our armed
+men who were still unhurt cheered wildly and opened a scattering fire
+on the soldiers. One or two soldiers fell; and I saw the officers
+going up and down the ranks urging the men to fire again; but they
+received the orders in sullen silence, and let the butts of their
+guns fall. Only one sergeant ran to a machine-gun and began to set
+it going; but a tall young man, an officer too, ran out of the ranks
+and dragged him back by the collar; and the soldiers stood there
+motionless while the horror-stricken crowd, nearly wholly unarmed
+(for most of the armed men had fallen in that first discharge),
+drifted out of the Square. I was told afterwards that the soldiers
+on the west side had fired also, and done their part of the
+slaughter. How I got out of the Square I scarcely know: I went, not
+feeling the ground under me, what with rage and terror and despair.'
+
+"So says our eye-witness. The number of the slain on the side of the
+people in that shooting during a minute was prodigious; but it was
+not easy to come at the truth about it; it was probably between one
+and two thousand. Of the soldiers, six were killed outright, and a
+dozen wounded."
+
+I listened, trembling with excitement. The old man's eyes glittered
+and his face flushed as he spoke, and told the tale of what I had
+often thought might happen. Yet I wondered that he should have got
+so elated about a mere massacre, and I said:
+
+"How fearful! And I suppose that this massacre put an end to the
+whole revolution for that time?"
+
+"No, no," cried old Hammond; "it began it!"
+
+He filled his glass and mine, and stood up and cried out, "Drink this
+glass to the memory of those who died there, for indeed it would be a
+long tale to tell how much we owe them."
+
+I drank, and he sat down again and went on.
+
+"That massacre of Trafalgar Square began the civil war, though, like
+all such events, it gathered head slowly, and people scarcely knew
+what a crisis they were acting in.
+
+"Terrible as the massacre was, and hideous and overpowering as the
+first terror had been, when the people had time to think about it,
+their feeling was one of anger rather than fear; although the
+military organisation of the state of siege was now carried out
+without shrinking by the clever young general. For though the
+ruling-classes when the news spread next morning felt one gasp of
+horror and even dread, yet the Government and their immediate backers
+felt that now the wine was drawn and must be drunk. However, even
+the most reactionary of the capitalist papers, with two exceptions,
+stunned by the tremendous news, simply gave an account of what had
+taken place, without making any comment upon it. The exceptions were
+one, a so-called 'liberal' paper (the Government of the day was of
+that complexion), which, after a preamble in which it declared its
+undeviating sympathy with the cause of labour, proceeded to point out
+that in times of revolutionary disturbance it behoved the Government
+to be just but firm, and that by far the most merciful way of dealing
+with the poor madmen who were attacking the very foundations of
+society (which had made them mad and poor) was to shoot them at once,
+so as to stop others from drifting into a position in which they
+would run a chance of being shot. In short, it praised the
+determined action of the Government as the acme of human wisdom and
+mercy, and exulted in the inauguration of an epoch of reasonable
+democracy free from the tyrannical fads of Socialism.
+
+"The other exception was a paper thought to be one of the most
+violent opponents of democracy, and so it was; but the editor of it
+found his manhood, and spoke for himself and not for his paper. In a
+few simple, indignant words he asked people to consider what a
+society was worth which had to be defended by the massacre of unarmed
+citizens, and called on the Government to withdraw their state of
+siege and put the general and his officers who fired on the people on
+their trial for murder. He went further, and declared that whatever
+his opinion might be as to the doctrines of the Socialists, he for
+one should throw in his lot with the people, until the Government
+atoned for their atrocity by showing that they were prepared to
+listen to the demands of men who knew what they wanted, and whom the
+decrepitude of society forced into pushing their demands in some way
+or other.
+
+"Of course, this editor was immediately arrested by the military
+power; but his bold words were already in the hands of the public,
+and produced a great effect: so great an effect that the Government,
+after some vacillation, withdrew the state of siege; though at the
+same time it strengthened the military organisation and made it more
+stringent. Three of the Committee of Public Safety had been slain in
+Trafalgar Square: of the rest the greater part went back to their
+old place of meeting, and there awaited the event calmly. They were
+arrested there on the Monday morning, and would have been shot at
+once by the general, who was a mere military machine, if the
+Government had not shrunk before the responsibility of killing men
+without any trial. There was at first a talk of trying them by a
+special commission of judges, as it was called--i.e., before a set of
+men bound to find them guilty, and whose business it was to do so.
+But with the Government the cold fit had succeeded to the hot one;
+and the prisoners were brought before a jury at the assizes. There a
+fresh blow awaited the Government; for in spite of the judge's
+charge, which distinctly instructed the jury to find the prisoners
+guilty, they were acquitted, and the jury added to their verdict a
+presentment, in which they condemned the action of the soldiery, in
+the queer phraseology of the day, as 'rash, unfortunate, and
+unnecessary.' The Committee of Public Safety renewed its sittings,
+and from thenceforth was a popular rallying-point in opposition to
+the Parliament. The Government now gave way on all sides, and made a
+show of yielding to the demands of the people, though there was a
+widespread plot for effecting a coup d'etat set on foot between the
+leaders of the two so-called opposing parties in the parliamentary
+faction fight. The well-meaning part of the public was overjoyed,
+and thought that all danger of a civil war was over. The victory of
+the people was celebrated by huge meetings held in the parks and
+elsewhere, in memory of the victims of the great massacre.
+
+"But the measures passed for the relief of the workers, though to the
+upper classes they seemed ruinously revolutionary, were not thorough
+enough to give the people food and a decent life, and they had to be
+supplemented by unwritten enactments without legality to back them.
+Although the Government and Parliament had the law-courts, the army,
+and 'society' at their backs, the Committee of Public Safety began to
+be a force in the country, and really represented the producing
+classes. It began to improve immensely in the days which followed on
+the acquittal of its members. Its old members had little
+administrative capacity, though with the exception of a few self-
+seekers and traitors, they were honest, courageous men, and many of
+them were endowed with considerable talent of other kinds. But now
+that the times called for immediate action, came forward the men
+capable of setting it on foot; and a new network of workmen's
+associations grew up very speedily, whose avowed single object was
+the tiding over of the ship of the community into a simple condition
+of Communism; and as they practically undertook also the management
+of the ordinary labour-war, they soon became the mouthpiece and
+intermediary of the whole of the working classes; and the
+manufacturing profit-grinders now found themselves powerless before
+this combination; unless THEIR committee, Parliament, plucked up
+courage to begin the civil war again, and to shoot right and left,
+they were bound to yield to the demands of the men whom they
+employed, and pay higher and higher wages for shorter and shorter
+day's work. Yet one ally they had, and that was the rapidly
+approaching breakdown of the whole system founded on the World-Market
+and its supply; which now became so clear to all people, that the
+middle classes, shocked for the moment into condemnation of the
+Government for the great massacre, turned round nearly in a mass, and
+called on the Government to look to matters, and put an end to the
+tyranny of the Socialist leaders.
+
+"Thus stimulated, the reactionist plot exploded probably before it
+was ripe; but this time the people and their leaders were forewarned,
+and, before the reactionaries could get under way, had taken the
+steps they thought necessary.
+
+"The Liberal Government (clearly by collusion) was beaten by the
+Conservatives, though the latter were nominally much in the minority.
+The popular representatives in the House understood pretty well what
+this meant, and after an attempt to fight the matter out by divisions
+in the House of Commons, they made a protest, left the House, and
+came in a body to the Committee of Public Safety: and the civil war
+began again in good earnest.
+
+"Yet its first act was not one of mere fighting. The new Tory
+Government determined to act, yet durst not re-enact the state of
+siege, but it sent a body of soldiers and police to arrest the
+Committee of Public Safety in the lump. They made no resistance,
+though they might have done so, as they had now a considerable body
+of men who were quite prepared for extremities. But they were
+determined to try first a weapon which they thought stronger than
+street fighting.
+
+"The members of the Committee went off quietly to prison; but they
+had left their soul and their organisation behind them. For they
+depended not on a carefully arranged centre with all kinds of checks
+and counter-checks about it, but on a huge mass of people in thorough
+sympathy with the movement, bound together by a great number of links
+of small centres with very simple instructions. These instructions
+were now carried out.
+
+"The next morning, when the leaders of the reaction were chuckling at
+the effect which the report in the newspapers of their stroke would
+have upon the public--no newspapers appeared; and it was only towards
+noon that a few straggling sheets, about the size of the gazettes of
+the seventeenth century, worked by policemen, soldiers, managers, and
+press-writers, were dribbled through the streets. They were greedily
+seized on and read; but by this time the serious part of their news
+was stale, and people did not need to be told that the GENERAL STRIKE
+had begun. The railways did not run, the telegraph-wires were
+unserved; flesh, fish, and green stuff brought to market was allowed
+to lie there still packed and perishing; the thousands of middle-
+class families, who were utterly dependant for the next meal on the
+workers, made frantic efforts through their more energetic members to
+cater for the needs of the day, and amongst those of them who could
+throw off the fear of what was to follow, there was, I am told, a
+certain enjoyment of this unexpected picnic--a forecast of the days
+to come, in which all labour grew pleasant.
+
+"So passed the first day, and towards evening the Government grew
+quite distracted. They had but one resource for putting down any
+popular movement--to wit, mere brute-force; but there was nothing for
+them against which to use their army and police: no armed bodies
+appeared in the streets; the offices of the Federated Workmen were
+now, in appearance, at least, turned into places for the relief of
+people thrown out of work, and under the circumstances, they durst
+not arrest the men engaged in such business, all the more, as even
+that night many quite respectable people applied at these offices for
+relief, and swallowed down the charity of the revolutionists along
+with their supper. So the Government massed soldiers and police here
+and there--and sat still for that night, fully expecting on the
+morrow some manifesto from 'the rebels,' as they now began to be
+called, which would give them an opportunity of acting in some way or
+another. They were disappointed. The ordinary newspapers gave up
+the struggle that morning, and only one very violent reactionary
+paper (called the Daily Telegraph) attempted an appearance, and rated
+'the rebels' in good set terms for their folly and ingratitude in
+tearing out the bowels of their 'common mother,' the English Nation,
+for the benefit of a few greedy paid agitators, and the fools whom
+they were deluding. On the other hand, the Socialist papers (of
+which three only, representing somewhat different schools, were
+published in London) came out full to the throat of well-printed
+matter. They were greedily bought by the whole public, who, of
+course, like the Government, expected a manifesto in them. But they
+found no word of reference to the great subject. It seemed as if
+their editors had ransacked their drawers for articles which would
+have been in place forty years before, under the technical name of
+educational articles. Most of these were admirable and
+straightforward expositions of the doctrines and practice of
+Socialism, free from haste and spite and hard words, and came upon
+the public with a kind of May-day freshness, amidst the worry and
+terror of the moment; and though the knowing well understood that the
+meaning of this move in the game was mere defiance, and a token of
+irreconcilable hostility to the then rulers of society, and though,
+also, they were meant for nothing else by 'the rebels,' yet they
+really had their effect as 'educational articles.' However,
+'education' of another kind was acting upon the public with
+irresistible power, and probably cleared their heads a little.
+
+"As to the Government, they were absolutely terrified by this act of
+'boycotting' (the slang word then current for such acts of
+abstention). Their counsels became wild and vacillating to the last
+degree: one hour they were for giving way for the present till they
+could hatch another plot; the next they all but sent an order for the
+arrest in the lump of all the workmen's committees; the next they
+were on the point of ordering their brisk young general to take any
+excuse that offered for another massacre. But when they called to
+mind that the soldiery in that 'Battle' of Trafalgar Square were so
+daunted by the slaughter which they had made, that they could not be
+got to fire a second volley, they shrank back again from the dreadful
+courage necessary for carrying out another massacre. Meantime the
+prisoners, brought the second time before the magistrates under a
+strong escort of soldiers, were the second time remanded.
+
+"The strike went on this day also. The workmen's committees were
+extended, and gave relief to great numbers of people, for they had
+organised a considerable amount of production of food by men whom
+they could depend upon. Quite a number of well-to-do people were now
+compelled to seek relief of them. But another curious thing
+happened: a band of young men of the upper classes armed themselves,
+and coolly went marauding in the streets, taking what suited them of
+such eatables and portables that they came across in the shops which
+had ventured to open. This operation they carried out in Oxford
+Street, then a great street of shops of all kinds. The Government,
+being at that hour in one of their yielding moods, thought this a
+fine opportunity for showing their impartiality in the maintenance of
+'order,' and sent to arrest these hungry rich youths; who, however,
+surprised the police by a valiant resistance, so that all but three
+escaped. The Government did not gain the reputation for impartiality
+which they expected from this move; for they forgot that there were
+no evening papers; and the account of the skirmish spread wide
+indeed, but in a distorted form for it was mostly told simply as an
+exploit of the starving people from the East-end; and everybody
+thought it was but natural for the Government to put them down when
+and where they could.
+
+"That evening the rebel prisoners were visited in their cells by VERY
+polite and sympathetic persons, who pointed out to them what a
+suicidal course they were following, and how dangerous these extreme
+courses were for the popular cause. Says one of the prisoners: 'It
+was great sport comparing notes when we came out anent the attempt of
+the Government to "get at" us separately in prison, and how we
+answered the blandishments of the highly "intelligent and refined"
+persons set on to pump us. One laughed; another told extravagant
+long-bow stories to the envoy; a third held a sulky silence; a fourth
+damned the polite spy and bade him hold his jaw--and that was all
+they got out of us.'
+
+"So passed the second day of the great strike. It was clear to all
+thinking people that the third day would bring on the crisis; for the
+present suspense and ill-concealed terror was unendurable. The
+ruling classes, and the middle-class non-politicians who had been
+their real strength and support, were as sheep lacking a shepherd;
+they literally did not know what to do.
+
+"One thing they found they had to do: try to get the 'rebels' to do
+something. So the next morning, the morning of the third day of the
+strike, when the members of the Committee of Public Safety appeared
+again before the magistrate, they found themselves treated with the
+greatest possible courtesy--in fact, rather as envoys and ambassadors
+than prisoners. In short, the magistrate had received his orders;
+and with no more to do than might come of a long stupid speech, which
+might have been written by Dickens in mockery, he discharged the
+prisoners, who went back to their meeting-place and at once began a
+due sitting. It was high time. For this third day the mass was
+fermenting indeed. There was, of course, a vast number of working
+people who were not organised in the least in the world; men who had
+been used to act as their masters drove them, or rather as the system
+drove, of which their masters were a part. That system was now
+falling to pieces, and the old pressure of the master having been
+taken off these poor men, it seemed likely that nothing but the mere
+animal necessities and passions of men would have any hold on them,
+and that mere general overturn would be the result. Doubtless this
+would have happened if it had not been that the huge mass had been
+leavened by Socialist opinion in the first place, and in the second
+by actual contact with declared Socialists, many or indeed most of
+whom were members of those bodies of workmen above said.
+
+If anything of this kind had happened some years before, when the
+masters of labour were still looked upon as the natural rulers of the
+people, and even the poorest and most ignorant man leaned upon them
+for support, while they submitted to their fleecing, the entire
+break-up of all society would have followed. But the long series of
+years during which the workmen had learned to despise their rulers,
+had done away with their dependence upon them, and they were now
+beginning to trust (somewhat dangerously, as events proved) in the
+non-legal leaders whom events had thrust forward; and though most of
+these were now become mere figure-heads, their names and reputations
+were useful in this crisis as a stop-gap.
+
+"The effect of the news, therefore, of the release of the Committee
+gave the Government some breathing time: for it was received with
+the greatest joy by the workers, and even the well-to-do saw in it a
+respite from the mere destruction which they had begun to dread, and
+the fear of which most of them attributed to the weakness of the
+Government. As far as the passing hour went, perhaps they were right
+in this."
+
+"How do you mean?" said I. "What could the Government have done? I
+often used to think that they would be helpless in such a crisis."
+
+Said old Hammond: "Of course I don't doubt that in the long run
+matters would have come about as they did. But if the Government
+could have treated their army as a real army, and used them
+strategically as a general would have done, looking on the people as
+a mere open enemy to be shot at and dispersed wherever they turned
+up, they would probably have gained the victory at the time."
+
+"But would the soldiers have acted against the people in this way?"
+said I.
+
+Said he: "I think from all I have heard that they would have done so
+if they had met bodies of men armed however badly, and however badly
+they had been organised. It seems also as if before the Trafalgar
+Square massacre they might as a whole have been depended upon to fire
+upon an unarmed crowd, though they were much honeycombed by
+Socialism. The reason for this was that they dreaded the use by
+apparently unarmed men of an explosive called dynamite, of which many
+loud boasts were made by the workers on the eve of these events;
+although it turned out to be of little use as a material for war in
+the way that was expected. Of course the officers of the soldiery
+fanned this fear to the utmost, so that the rank and file probably
+thought on that occasion that they were being led into a desperate
+battle with men who were really armed, and whose weapon was the more
+dreadful, because it was concealed. After that massacre, however, it
+was at all times doubtful if the regular soldiers would fire upon an
+unarmed or half-armed crowd."
+
+Said I: "The regular soldiers? Then there were other combatants
+against the people?"
+
+"Yes," said he, "we shall come to that presently."
+
+"Certainly," I said, "you had better go on straight with your story.
+I see that time is wearing."
+
+Said Hammond: "The Government lost no time in coming to terms with
+the Committee of Public Safety; for indeed they could think of
+nothing else than the danger of the moment. They sent a duly
+accredited envoy to treat with these men, who somehow had obtained
+dominion over people's minds, while the formal rulers had no hold
+except over their bodies. There is no need at present to go into the
+details of the truce (for such it was) between these high contracting
+parties, the Government of the empire of Great Britain and a handful
+of working-men (as they were called in scorn in those days), amongst
+whom, indeed, were some very capable and 'square-headed' persons,
+though, as aforesaid, the abler men were not then the recognised
+leaders. The upshot of it was that all the definite claims of the
+people had to be granted. We can now see that most of these claims
+were of themselves not worth either demanding or resisting; but they
+were looked on at that time as most important, and they were at least
+tokens of revolt against the miserable system of life which was then
+beginning to tumble to pieces. One claim, however, was of the utmost
+immediate importance, and this the Government tried hard to evade;
+but as they were not dealing with fools, they had to yield at last.
+This was the claim of recognition and formal status for the Committee
+of Public Safety, and all the associations which it fostered under
+its wing. This it is clear meant two things: first, amnesty for
+'the rebels,' great and small, who, without a distinct act of civil
+war, could no longer be attacked; and next, a continuance of the
+organised revolution. Only one point the Government could gain, and
+that was a name. The dreadful revolutionary title was dropped, and
+the body, with its branches, acted under the respectable name of the
+'Board of Conciliation and its local offices.' Carrying this name,
+it became the leader of the people in the civil war which soon
+followed."
+
+"O," said I, somewhat startled, "so the civil war went on, in spite
+of all that had happened?"
+
+"So it was," said he. "In fact, it was this very legal recognition
+which made the civil war possible in the ordinary sense of war; it
+took the struggle out of the element of mere massacres on one side,
+and endurance plus strikes on the other."
+
+"And can you tell me in what kind of way the war was carried on?"
+said I.
+
+"Yes" he said; "we have records and to spare of all that; and the
+essence of them I can give you in a few words. As I told you, the
+rank and file of the army was not to be trusted by the reactionists;
+but the officers generally were prepared for anything, for they were
+mostly the very stupidest men in the country. Whatever the
+Government might do, a great part of the upper and middle classes
+were determined to set on foot a counter revolution; for the
+Communism which now loomed ahead seemed quite unendurable to them.
+Bands of young men, like the marauders in the great strike of whom I
+told you just now, armed themselves and drilled, and began on any
+opportunity or pretence to skirmish with the people in the streets.
+The Government neither helped them nor put them down, but stood by,
+hoping that something might come of it. These 'Friends of Order,' as
+they were called, had some successes at first, and grew bolder; they
+got many officers of the regular army to help them, and by their
+means laid hold of munitions of war of all kinds. One part of their
+tactics consisted in their guarding and even garrisoning the big
+factories of the period: they held at one time, for instance, the
+whole of that place called Manchester which I spoke of just now. A
+sort of irregular war was carried on with varied success all over the
+country; and at last the Government, which at first pretended to
+ignore the struggle, or treat it as mere rioting, definitely declared
+for 'the Friends of Order,' and joined to their bands whatsoever of
+the regular army they could get together, and made a desperate effort
+to overwhelm 'the rebels,' as they were now once more called, and as
+indeed they called themselves.
+
+"It was too late. All ideas of peace on a basis of compromise had
+disappeared on either side. The end, it was seen clearly, must be
+either absolute slavery for all but the privileged, or a system of
+life founded on equality and Communism. The sloth, the hopelessness,
+and if I may say so, the cowardice of the last century, had given
+place to the eager, restless heroism of a declared revolutionary
+period. I will not say that the people of that time foresaw the life
+we are leading now, but there was a general instinct amongst them
+towards the essential part of that life, and many men saw clearly
+beyond the desperate struggle of the day into the peace which it was
+to bring about. The men of that day who were on the side of freedom
+were not unhappy, I think, though they were harassed by hopes and
+fears, and sometimes torn by doubts, and the conflict of duties hard
+to reconcile."
+
+"But how did the people, the revolutionists, carry on the war? What
+were the elements of success on their side?"
+
+I put this question, because I wanted to bring the old man back to
+the definite history, and take him out of the musing mood so natural
+to an old man.
+
+He answered: "Well, they did not lack organisers; for the very
+conflict itself, in days when, as I told you, men of any strength of
+mind cast away all consideration for the ordinary business of life,
+developed the necessary talent amongst them. Indeed, from all I have
+read and heard, I much doubt whether, without this seemingly dreadful
+civil war, the due talent for administration would have been
+developed amongst the working men. Anyhow, it was there, and they
+soon got leaders far more than equal to the best men amongst the
+reactionaries. For the rest, they had no difficulty about the
+material of their army; for that revolutionary instinct so acted on
+the ordinary soldier in the ranks that the greater part, certainly
+the best part, of the soldiers joined the side of the people. But
+the main element of their success was this, that wherever the working
+people were not coerced, they worked, not for the reactionists, but
+for 'the rebels.' The reactionists could get no work done for them
+outside the districts where they were all-powerful: and even in
+those districts they were harassed by continual risings; and in all
+cases and everywhere got nothing done without obstruction and black
+looks and sulkiness; so that not only were their armies quite worn
+out with the difficulties which they had to meet, but the non-
+combatants who were on their side were so worried and beset with
+hatred and a thousand little troubles and annoyances that life became
+almost unendurable to them on those terms. Not a few of them
+actually died of the worry; many committed suicide. Of course, a
+vast number of them joined actively in the cause of reaction, and
+found some solace to their misery in the eagerness of conflict.
+Lastly, many thousands gave way and submitted to 'the rebels'; and as
+the numbers of these latter increased, it at last became clear to all
+men that the cause which was once hopeless, was now triumphant, and
+that the hopeless cause was that of slavery and privilege."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII: THE BEGINNING OF THE NEW LIFE
+
+
+
+"Well," said I, "so you got clear out of all your trouble. Were
+people satisfied with the new order of things when it came?"
+
+"People?" he said. "Well, surely all must have been glad of peace
+when it came; especially when they found, as they must have found,
+that after all, they--even the once rich--were not living very badly.
+As to those who had been poor, all through the war, which lasted
+about two years, their condition had been bettering, in spite of the
+struggle; and when peace came at last, in a very short time they made
+great strides towards a decent life. The great difficulty was that
+the once-poor had such a feeble conception of the real pleasure of
+life: so to say, they did not ask enough, did not know how to ask
+enough, from the new state of things. It was perhaps rather a good
+than an evil thing that the necessity for restoring the wealth
+destroyed during the war forced them into working at first almost as
+hard as they had been used to before the Revolution. For all
+historians are agreed that there never was a war in which there was
+so much destruction of wares, and instruments for making them as in
+this civil war."
+
+"I am rather surprised at that," said I.
+
+"Are you? I don't see why," said Hammond.
+
+"Why," I said, "because the party of order would surely look upon the
+wealth as their own property, no share of which, if they could help
+it, should go to their slaves, supposing they conquered. And on the
+other hand, it was just for the possession of that wealth that 'the
+rebels' were fighting, and I should have thought, especially when
+they saw that they were winning, that they would have been careful to
+destroy as little as possible of what was so soon to be their own."
+
+"It was as I have told you, however," said he. "The party of order,
+when they recovered from their first cowardice of surprise--or, if
+you please, when they fairly saw that, whatever happened, they would
+be ruined, fought with great bitterness, and cared little what they
+did, so long as they injured the enemies who had destroyed the sweets
+of life for them. As to 'the rebels,' I have told you that the
+outbreak of actual war made them careless of trying to save the
+wretched scraps of wealth that they had. It was a common saying
+amongst them, Let the country be cleared of everything except valiant
+living men, rather than that we fall into slavery again!"
+
+He sat silently thinking a little while, and then said:
+
+"When the conflict was once really begun, it was seen how little of
+any value there was in the old world of slavery and inequality.
+Don't you see what it means? In the times which you are thinking of,
+and of which you seem to know so much, there was no hope; nothing but
+the dull jog of the mill-horse under compulsion of collar and whip;
+but in that fighting-time that followed, all was hope: 'the rebels'
+at least felt themselves strong enough to build up the world again
+from its dry bones,--and they did it, too!" said the old man, his
+eyes glittering under his beetling brows. He went on: "And their
+opponents at least and at last learned something about the reality of
+life, and its sorrows, which they--their class, I mean--had once
+known nothing of. In short, the two combatants, the workman and the
+gentleman, between them--"
+
+"Between them," said I, quickly, "they destroyed commercialism!"
+
+"Yes, yes, yes," said he; "that is it. Nor could it have been
+destroyed otherwise; except, perhaps, by the whole of society
+gradually falling into lower depths, till it should at last reach a
+condition as rude as barbarism, but lacking both the hope and the
+pleasures of barbarism. Surely the sharper, shorter remedy was the
+happiest."
+
+"Most surely," said I.
+
+"Yes," said the old man, "the world was being brought to its second
+birth; how could that take place without a tragedy? Moreover, think
+of it. The spirit of the new days, of our days, was to be delight in
+the life of the world; intense and overweening love of the very skin
+and surface of the earth on which man dwells, such as a lover has in
+the fair flesh of the woman he loves; this, I say, was to be the new
+spirit of the time. All other moods save this had been exhausted:
+the unceasing criticism, the boundless curiosity in the ways and
+thoughts of man, which was the mood of the ancient Greek, to whom
+these things were not so much a means, as an end, was gone past
+recovery; nor had there been really any shadow of it in the so-called
+science of the nineteenth century, which, as you must know, was in
+the main an appendage to the commercial system; nay, not seldom an
+appendage to the police of that system. In spite of appearances, it
+was limited and cowardly, because it did not really believe in
+itself. It was the outcome, as it was the sole relief, of the
+unhappiness of the period which made life so bitter even to the rich,
+and which, as you may see with your bodily eyes, the great change has
+swept away. More akin to our way of looking at life was the spirit
+of the Middle Ages, to whom heaven and the life of the next world was
+such a reality, that it became to them a part of the life upon the
+earth; which accordingly they loved and adorned, in spite of the
+ascetic doctrines of their formal creed, which bade them contemn it.
+
+"But that also, with its assured belief in heaven and hell as two
+countries in which to live, has gone, and now we do, both in word and
+in deed, believe in the continuous life of the world of men, and as
+it were, add every day of that common life to the little stock of
+days which our own mere individual experience wins for us: and
+consequently we are happy. Do you wonder at it? In times past,
+indeed, men were told to love their kind, to believe in the religion
+of humanity, and so forth. But look you, just in the degree that a
+man had elevation of mind and refinement enough to be able to value
+this idea, was he repelled by the obvious aspect of the individuals
+composing the mass which he was to worship; and he could only evade
+that repulsion by making a conventional abstraction of mankind that
+had little actual or historical relation to the race; which to his
+eyes was divided into blind tyrants on the one hand and apathetic
+degraded slaves on the other. But now, where is the difficulty in
+accepting the religion of humanity, when the men and women who go to
+make up humanity are free, happy, and energetic at least, and most
+commonly beautiful of body also, and surrounded by beautiful things
+of their own fashioning, and a nature bettered and not worsened by
+contact with mankind? This is what this age of the world has
+reserved for us."
+
+"It seems true," said I, "or ought to be, if what my eyes have seen
+is a token of the general life you lead. Can you now tell me
+anything of your progress after the years of the struggle?"
+
+Said he: "I could easily tell you more than you have time to listen
+to; but I can at least hint at one of the chief difficulties which
+had to be met: and that was, that when men began to settle down
+after the war, and their labour had pretty much filled up the gap in
+wealth caused by the destruction of that war, a kind of
+disappointment seemed coming over us, and the prophecies of some of
+the reactionists of past times seemed as if they would come true, and
+a dull level of utilitarian comfort be the end for a while of our
+aspirations and success. The loss of the competitive spur to
+exertion had not, indeed, done anything to interfere with the
+necessary production of the community, but how if it should make men
+dull by giving them too much time for thought or idle musing? But,
+after all, this dull thunder-cloud only threatened us, and then
+passed over. Probably, from what I have told you before, you will
+have a guess at the remedy for such a disaster; remembering always
+that many of the things which used to be produced--slave-wares for
+the poor and mere wealth-wasting wares for the rich--ceased to be
+made. That remedy was, in short, the production of what used to be
+called art, but which has no name amongst us now, because it has
+become a necessary part of the labour of every man who produces."
+
+Said I: "What! had men any time or opportunity for cultivating the
+fine arts amidst the desperate struggle for life and freedom that you
+have told me of?"
+
+Said Hammond: "You must not suppose that the new form of art was
+founded chiefly on the memory of the art of the past; although,
+strange to say, the civil war was much less destructive of art than
+of other things, and though what of art existed under the old forms,
+revived in a wonderful way during the latter part of the struggle,
+especially as regards music and poetry. The art or work-pleasure, as
+one ought to call it, of which I am now speaking, sprung up almost
+spontaneously, it seems, from a kind of instinct amongst people, no
+longer driven desperately to painful and terrible over-work, to do
+the best they could with the work in hand--to make it excellent of
+its kind; and when that had gone on for a little, a craving for
+beauty seemed to awaken in men's minds, and they began rudely and
+awkwardly to ornament the wares which they made; and when they had
+once set to work at that, it soon began to grow. All this was much
+helped by the abolition of the squalor which our immediate ancestors
+put up with so coolly; and by the leisurely, but not stupid, country-
+life which now grew (as I told you before) to be common amongst us.
+Thus at last and by slow degrees we got pleasure into our work; then
+we became conscious of that pleasure, and cultivated it, and took
+care that we had our fill of it; and then all was gained, and we were
+happy. So may it be for ages and ages!"
+
+The old man fell into a reverie, not altogether without melancholy I
+thought; but I would not break it. Suddenly he started, and said:
+"Well, dear guest, here are come Dick and Clara to fetch you away,
+and there is an end of my talk; which I daresay you will not be sorry
+for; the long day is coming to an end, and you will have a pleasant
+ride back to Hammersmith."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX: THE DRIVE BACK TO HAMMERSMITH
+
+
+
+I said nothing, for I was not inclined for mere politeness to him
+after such very serious talk; but in fact I should liked to have gone
+on talking with the older man, who could understand something at
+least of my wonted ways of looking at life, whereas, with the younger
+people, in spite of all their kindness, I really was a being from
+another planet. However, I made the best of it, and smiled as
+amiably as I could on the young couple; and Dick returned the smile
+by saying, "Well, guest, I am glad to have you again, and to find
+that you and my kinsman have not quite talked yourselves into another
+world; I was half suspecting as I was listening to the Welshmen
+yonder that you would presently be vanishing away from us, and began
+to picture my kinsman sitting in the hall staring at nothing and
+finding that he had been talking a while past to nobody."
+
+I felt rather uncomfortable at this speech, for suddenly the picture
+of the sordid squabble, the dirty and miserable tragedy of the life I
+had left for a while, came before my eyes; and I had, as it were, a
+vision of all my longings for rest and peace in the past, and I
+loathed the idea of going back to it again. But the old man chuckled
+and said:
+
+"Don't be afraid, Dick. In any case, I have not been talking to thin
+air; nor, indeed to this new friend of ours only. Who knows but I
+may not have been talking to many people? For perhaps our guest may
+some day go back to the people he has come from, and may take a
+message from us which may bear fruit for them, and consequently for
+us."
+
+Dick looked puzzled, and said: "Well, gaffer, I do not quite
+understand what you mean. All I can say is, that I hope he will not
+leave us: for don't you see, he is another kind of man to what we
+are used to, and somehow he makes us think of all kind of things; and
+already I feel as if I could understand Dickens the better for having
+talked with him."
+
+"Yes," said Clara, "and I think in a few months we shall make him
+look younger; and I should like to see what he was like with the
+wrinkles smoothed out of his face. Don't you think he will look
+younger after a little time with us?"
+
+The old man shook his head, and looked earnestly at me, but did not
+answer her, and for a moment or two we were all silent. Then Clara
+broke out:
+
+"Kinsman, I don't like this: something or another troubles me, and I
+feel as if something untoward were going to happen. You have been
+talking of past miseries to the guest, and have been living in past
+unhappy times, and it is in the air all round us, and makes us feel
+as if we were longing for something that we cannot have."
+
+The old man smiled on her kindly, and said: "Well, my child, if that
+be so, go and live in the present, and you will soon shake it off."
+Then he turned to me, and said: "Do you remember anything like that,
+guest, in the country from which you come?"
+
+The lovers had turned aside now, and were talking together softly,
+and not heeding us; so I said, but in a low voice: "Yes, when I was
+a happy child on a sunny holiday, and had everything that I could
+think of."
+
+"So it is," said he. "You remember just now you twitted me with
+living in the second childhood of the world. You will find it a
+happy world to live in; you will be happy there--for a while."
+
+Again I did not like his scarcely veiled threat, and was beginning to
+trouble myself with trying to remember how I had got amongst this
+curious people, when the old man called out in a cheery voice: "Now,
+my children, take your guest away, and make much of him; for it is
+your business to make him sleek of skin and peaceful of mind: he has
+by no means been as lucky as you have. Farewell, guest!" and he
+grasped my hand warmly.
+
+"Good-bye," said I, "and thank you very much for all that you have
+told me. I will come and see you as soon as I come back to London.
+May I?"
+
+"Yes," he said, "come by all means--if you can."
+
+"It won't be for some time yet," quoth Dick, in his cheery voice;
+"for when the hay is in up the river, I shall be for taking him a
+round through the country between hay and wheat harvest, to see how
+our friends live in the north country. Then in the wheat harvest we
+shall do a good stroke of work, I should hope,--in Wiltshire by
+preference; for he will be getting a little hard with all the open-
+air living, and I shall be as tough as nails."
+
+"But you will take me along, won't you, Dick?" said Clara, laying her
+pretty hand on his shoulder.
+
+"Will I not?" said Dick, somewhat boisterously. "And we will manage
+to send you to bed pretty tired every night; and you will look so
+beautiful with your neck all brown, and your hands too, and you under
+your gown as white as privet, that you will get some of those strange
+discontented whims out of your head, my dear. However, our week's
+haymaking will do all that for you."
+
+The girl reddened very prettily, and not for shame but for pleasure;
+and the old man laughed, and said:
+
+"Guest, I see that you will be as comfortable as need be; for you
+need not fear that those two will be too officious with you: they
+will be so busy with each other, that they will leave you a good deal
+to yourself, I am sure, and that is a real kindness to a guest, after
+all. O, you need not be afraid of being one too many, either: it is
+just what these birds in a nest like, to have a good convenient
+friend to turn to, so that they may relieve the ecstasies of love
+with the solid commonplace of friendship. Besides, Dick, and much
+more Clara, likes a little talking at times; and you know lovers do
+not talk unless they get into trouble, they only prattle. Good-bye,
+guest; may you be happy!"
+
+Clara went up to old Hammond, threw her arms about his neck and
+kissed him heartily, and said:
+
+"You are a dear old man, and may have your jest about me as much as
+you please; and it won't be long before we see you again; and you may
+be sure we shall make our guest happy; though, mind you, there is
+some truth in what you say."
+
+Then I shook hands again, and we went out of the hall and into the
+cloisters, and so in the street found Greylocks in the shafts waiting
+for us. He was well looked after; for a little lad of about seven
+years old had his hand on the rein and was solemnly looking up into
+his face; on his back, withal, was a girl of fourteen, holding a
+three-year old sister on before her; while another girl, about a year
+older than the boy, hung on behind. The three were occupied partly
+with eating cherries, partly with patting and punching Greylocks, who
+took all their caresses in good part, but pricked up his ears when
+Dick made his appearance. The girls got off quietly, and going up to
+Clara, made much of her and snuggled up to her. And then we got into
+the carriage, Dick shook the reins, and we got under way at once,
+Greylocks trotting soberly between the lovely trees of the London
+streets, that were sending floods of fragrance into the cool evening
+air; for it was now getting toward sunset.
+
+We could hardly go but fair and softly all the way, as there were a
+great many people abroad in that cool hour. Seeing so many people
+made me notice their looks the more; and I must say, my taste,
+cultivated in the sombre greyness, or rather brownness, of the
+nineteenth century, was rather apt to condemn the gaiety and
+brightness of the raiment; and I even ventured to say as much to
+Clara. She seemed rather surprised, and even slightly indignant, and
+said: "Well, well, what's the matter? They are not about any dirty
+work; they are only amusing themselves in the fine evening; there is
+nothing to foul their clothes. Come, doesn't it all look very
+pretty? It isn't gaudy, you know."
+
+Indeed that was true; for many of the people were clad in colours
+that were sober enough, though beautiful, and the harmony of the
+colours was perfect and most delightful.
+
+I said, "Yes, that is so; but how can everybody afford such costly
+garments? Look! there goes a middle-aged man in a sober grey dress;
+but I can see from here that it is made of very fine woollen stuff,
+and is covered with silk embroidery."
+
+Said Clara: "He could wear shabby clothes if he pleased,--that is,
+if he didn't think he would hurt people's feelings by doing so."
+
+"But please tell me," said I, "how can they afford it?"
+
+As soon as I had spoken I perceived that I had got back to my old
+blunder; for I saw Dick's shoulders shaking with laughter; but he
+wouldn't say a word, but handed me over to the tender mercies of
+Clara, who said -
+
+"Why, I don't know what you mean. Of course we can afford it, or
+else we shouldn't do it. It would be easy enough for us to say, we
+will only spend our labour on making our clothes comfortable: but we
+don't choose to stop there. Why do you find fault with us? Does it
+seem to you as if we starved ourselves of food in order to make
+ourselves fine clothes? Or do you think there is anything wrong in
+liking to see the coverings of our bodies beautiful like our bodies
+are?--just as a deer's or an otter's skin has been made beautiful
+from the first? Come, what is wrong with you?"
+
+I bowed before the storm, and mumbled out some excuse or other. I
+must say, I might have known that people who were so fond of
+architecture generally, would not be backward in ornamenting
+themselves; all the more as the shape of their raiment, apart from
+its colour, was both beautiful and reasonable--veiling the form,
+without either muffling or caricaturing it.
+
+Clara was soon mollified; and as we drove along toward the wood
+before mentioned, she said to Dick -
+
+"I tell you what, Dick: now that kinsman Hammond the Elder has seen
+our guest in his queer clothes, I think we ought to find him
+something decent to put on for our journey to-morrow: especially
+since, if we do not, we shall have to answer all sorts of questions
+as to his clothes and where they came from. Besides," she said
+slily, "when he is clad in handsome garments he will not be so quick
+to blame us for our childishness in wasting our time in making
+ourselves look pleasant to each other."
+
+"All right, Clara," said Dick; "he shall have everything that you--
+that he wants to have. I will look something out for him before he
+gets up to-morrow."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX: THE HAMMERSMITH GUEST-HOUSE AGAIN
+
+
+
+Amidst such talk, driving quietly through the balmy evening, we came
+to Hammersmith, and were well received by our friends there. Boffin,
+in a fresh suit of clothes, welcomed me back with stately courtesy;
+the weaver wanted to button-hole me and get out of me what old
+Hammond had said, but was very friendly and cheerful when Dick warned
+him off; Annie shook hands with me, and hoped I had had a pleasant
+day--so kindly, that I felt a slight pang as our hands parted; for to
+say the truth, I liked her better than Clara, who seemed to be always
+a little on the defensive, whereas Annie was as frank as could be,
+and seemed to get honest pleasure from everything and everybody about
+her without the least effort.
+
+We had quite a little feast that evening, partly in my honour, and
+partly, I suspect, though nothing was said about it, in honour of
+Dick and Clara coming together again. The wine was of the best; the
+hall was redolent of rich summer flowers; and after supper we not
+only had music (Annie, to my mind, surpassing all the others for
+sweetness and clearness of voice, as well as for feeling and
+meaning), but at last we even got to telling stories, and sat there
+listening, with no other light but that of the summer moon streaming
+through the beautiful traceries of the windows, as if we had belonged
+to time long passed, when books were scarce and the art of reading
+somewhat rare. Indeed, I may say here, that, though, as you will
+have noted, my friends had mostly something to say about books, yet
+they were not great readers, considering the refinement of their
+manners and the great amount of leisure which they obviously had. In
+fact, when Dick, especially, mentioned a book, he did so with an air
+of a man who has accomplished an achievement; as much as to say,
+"There, you see, I have actually read that!"
+
+The evening passed all too quickly for me; since that day, for the
+first time in my life, I was having my fill of the pleasure of the
+eyes without any of that sense of incongruity, that dread of
+approaching ruin, which had always beset me hitherto when I had been
+amongst the beautiful works of art of the past, mingled with the
+lovely nature of the present; both of them, in fact, the result of
+the long centuries of tradition, which had compelled men to produce
+the art, and compelled nature to run into the mould of the ages.
+Here I could enjoy everything without an afterthought of the
+injustice and miserable toil which made my leisure; the ignorance and
+dulness of life which went to make my keen appreciation of history;
+the tyranny and the struggle full of fear and mishap which went to
+make my romance. The only weight I had upon my heart was a vague
+fear as it drew toward bed-time concerning the place wherein I should
+wake on the morrow: but I choked that down, and went to bed happy,
+and in a very few moments was in a dreamless sleep.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI: GOING UP THE RIVER
+
+
+
+When I did wake, to a beautiful sunny morning, I leapt out of bed
+with my over-night apprehension still clinging to me, which vanished
+delightfully however in a moment as I looked around my little
+sleeping chamber and saw the pale but pure-coloured figures painted
+on the plaster of the wall, with verses written underneath them which
+I knew somewhat over well. I dressed speedily, in a suit of blue
+laid ready for me, so handsome that I quite blushed when I had got
+into it, feeling as I did so that excited pleasure of anticipation of
+a holiday, which, well remembered as it was, I had not felt since I
+was a boy, new come home for the summer holidays.
+
+It seemed quite early in the morning, and I expected to have the hall
+to myself when I came into it out of the corridor wherein was my
+sleeping chamber; but I met Annie at once, who let fall her broom and
+gave me a kiss, quite meaningless I fear, except as betokening
+friendship, though she reddened as she did it, not from shyness, but
+from friendly pleasure, and then stood and picked up her broom again,
+and went on with her sweeping, nodding to me as if to bid me stand
+out of the way and look on; which, to say the truth, I thought
+amusing enough, as there were five other girls helping her, and their
+graceful figures engaged in the leisurely work were worth going a
+long way to see, and their merry talk and laughing as they swept in
+quite a scientific manner was worth going a long way to hear. But
+Annie presently threw me back a word or two as she went on to the
+other end of the hall: "Guest," she said, "I am glad that you are up
+early, though we wouldn't disturb you; for our Thames is a lovely
+river at half-past six on a June morning: and as it would be a pity
+for you to lose it, I am told just to give you a cup of milk and a
+bit of bread outside there, and put you into the boat: for Dick and
+Clara are all ready now. Wait half a minute till I have swept down
+this row."
+
+So presently she let her broom drop again, and came and took me by
+the hand and led me out on to the terrace above the river, to a
+little table under the boughs, where my bread and milk took the form
+of as dainty a breakfast as any one could desire, and then sat by me
+as I ate. And in a minute or two Dick and Clara came to me, the
+latter looking most fresh and beautiful in a light silk embroidered
+gown, which to my unused eyes was extravagantly gay and bright; while
+Dick was also handsomely dressed in white flannel prettily
+embroidered. Clara raised her gown in her hands as she gave me the
+morning greeting, and said laughingly: "Look, guest! you see we are
+at least as fine as any of the people you felt inclined to scold last
+night; you see we are not going to make the bright day and the
+flowers feel ashamed of themselves. Now scold me!"
+
+Quoth I: "No, indeed; the pair of you seem as if you were born out
+of the summer day itself; and I will scold you when I scold it."
+
+"Well, you know," said Dick, "this is a special day--all these days
+are, I mean. The hay-harvest is in some ways better than corn-
+harvest because of the beautiful weather; and really, unless you had
+worked in the hay-field in fine weather, you couldn't tell what
+pleasant work it is. The women look so pretty at it, too," he said,
+shyly; "so all things considered, I think we are right to adorn it in
+a simple manner."
+
+"Do the women work at it in silk dresses?" said I, smiling.
+
+Dick was going to answer me soberly; but Clara put her hand over his
+mouth, and said, "No, no, Dick; not too much information for him, or
+I shall think that you are your old kinsman again. Let him find out
+for himself: he will not have long to wait."
+
+"Yes," quoth Annie, "don't make your description of the picture too
+fine, or else he will be disappointed when the curtain is drawn. I
+don't want him to be disappointed. But now it's time for you to be
+gone, if you are to have the best of the tide, and also of the sunny
+morning. Good-bye, guest."
+
+She kissed me in her frank friendly way, and almost took away from me
+my desire for the expedition thereby; but I had to get over that, as
+it was clear that so delightful a woman would hardly be without a due
+lover of her own age. We went down the steps of the landing stage,
+and got into a pretty boat, not too light to hold us and our
+belongings comfortably, and handsomely ornamented; and just as we got
+in, down came Boffin and the weaver to see us off. The former had
+now veiled his splendour in a due suit of working clothes, crowned
+with a fantail hat, which he took off, however, to wave us farewell
+with his grave old-Spanish-like courtesy. Then Dick pushed off into
+the stream, and bent vigorously to his sculls, and Hammersmith, with
+its noble trees and beautiful water-side houses, began to slip away
+from us.
+
+As we went, I could not help putting beside his promised picture of
+the hay-field as it was then the picture of it as I remembered it,
+and especially the images of the women engaged in the work rose up
+before me: the row of gaunt figures, lean, flat-breasted, ugly,
+without a grace of form or face about them; dressed in wretched
+skimpy print gowns, and hideous flapping sun-bonnets, moving their
+rakes in a listless mechanical way. How often had that marred the
+loveliness of the June day to me; how often had I longed to see the
+hay-fields peopled with men and women worthy of the sweet abundance
+of midsummer, of its endless wealth of beautiful sights, and
+delicious sounds and scents. And now, the world had grown old and
+wiser, and I was to see my hope realised at last!
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII: HAMPTON COURT AND A PRAISER OF PAST TIMES
+
+
+
+So on we went, Dick rowing in an easy tireless way, and Clara sitting
+by my side admiring his manly beauty and heartily good-natured face,
+and thinking, I fancy, of nothing else. As we went higher up the
+river, there was less difference between the Thames of that day and
+Thames as I remembered it; for setting aside the hideous vulgarity of
+the cockney villas of the well-to-do, stockbrokers and other such,
+which in older time marred the beauty of the bough-hung banks, even
+this beginning of the country Thames was always beautiful; and as we
+slipped between the lovely summer greenery, I almost felt my youth
+come back to me, and as if I were on one of those water excursions
+which I used to enjoy so much in days when I was too happy to think
+that there could be much amiss anywhere.
+
+At last we came to a reach of the river where on the left hand a very
+pretty little village with some old houses in it came down to the
+edge of the water, over which was a ferry; and beyond these houses
+the elm-beset meadows ended in a fringe of tall willows, while on the
+right hand went the tow-path and a clear space before a row of trees,
+which rose up behind huge and ancient, the ornaments of a great park:
+but these drew back still further from the river at the end of the
+reach to make way for a little town of quaint and pretty houses, some
+new, some old, dominated by the long walls and sharp gables of a
+great red-brick pile of building, partly of the latest Gothic, partly
+of the court-style of Dutch William, but so blended together by the
+bright sun and beautiful surroundings, including the bright blue
+river, which it looked down upon, that even amidst the beautiful
+buildings of that new happy time it had a strange charm about it. A
+great wave of fragrance, amidst which the lime-tree blossom was
+clearly to be distinguished, came down to us from its unseen gardens,
+as Clara sat up in her place, and said:
+
+"O Dick, dear, couldn't we stop at Hampton Court for to-day, and take
+the guest about the park a little, and show him those sweet old
+buildings? Somehow, I suppose because you have lived so near it, you
+have seldom taken me to Hampton Court."
+
+Dick rested on his oars a little, and said: "Well, well, Clara, you
+are lazy to-day. I didn't feel like stopping short of Shepperton for
+the night; suppose we just go and have our dinner at the Court, and
+go on again about five o'clock?"
+
+"Well," she said, "so be it; but I should like the guest to have
+spent an hour or two in the Park."
+
+"The Park!" said Dick; "why, the whole Thames-side is a park this
+time of the year; and for my part, I had rather lie under an elm-tree
+on the borders of a wheat-field, with the bees humming about me and
+the corn-crake crying from furrow to furrow, than in any park in
+England. Besides--"
+
+"Besides," said she, "you want to get on to your dearly-loved upper
+Thames, and show your prowess down the heavy swathes of the mowing
+grass."
+
+She looked at him fondly, and I could tell that she was seeing him in
+her mind's eye showing his splendid form at its best amidst the
+rhymed strokes of the scythes; and she looked down at her own pretty
+feet with a half sigh, as though she were contrasting her slight
+woman's beauty with his man's beauty; as women will when they are
+really in love, and are not spoiled with conventional sentiment.
+
+As for Dick, he looked at her admiringly a while, and then said at
+last: "Well, Clara, I do wish we were there! But, hilloa! we are
+getting back way." And he set to work sculling again, and in two
+minutes we were all standing on the gravelly strand below the bridge,
+which, as you may imagine, was no longer the old hideous iron
+abortion, but a handsome piece of very solid oak framing.
+
+We went into the Court and straight into the great hall, so well
+remembered, where there were tables spread for dinner, and everything
+arranged much as in Hammersmith Guest-Hall. Dinner over, we
+sauntered through the ancient rooms, where the pictures and tapestry
+were still preserved, and nothing was much changed, except that the
+people whom we met there had an indefinable kind of look of being at
+home and at ease, which communicated itself to me, so that I felt
+that the beautiful old place was mine in the best sense of the word;
+and my pleasure of past days seemed to add itself to that of to-day,
+and filled my whole soul with content.
+
+Dick (who, in spite of Clara's gibe, knew the place very well) told
+me that the beautiful old Tudor rooms, which I remembered had been
+the dwellings of the lesser fry of Court flunkies, were now much used
+by people coming and going; for, beautiful as architecture had now
+become, and although the whole face of the country had quite
+recovered its beauty, there was still a sort of tradition of pleasure
+and beauty which clung to that group of buildings, and people thought
+going to Hampton Court a necessary summer outing, as they did in the
+days when London was so grimy and miserable. We went into some of
+the rooms looking into the old garden, and were well received by the
+people in them, who got speedily into talk with us, and looked with
+politely half-concealed wonder at my strange face. Besides these
+birds of passage, and a few regular dwellers in the place, we saw out
+in the meadows near the garden, down "the Long Water," as it used to
+be called, many gay tents with men, women, and children round about
+them. As it seemed, this pleasure-loving people were fond of tent-
+life, with all its inconveniences, which, indeed, they turned into
+pleasure also.
+
+We left this old friend by the time appointed, and I made some feeble
+show of taking the sculls; but Dick repulsed me, not much to my
+grief, I must say, as I found I had quite enough to do between the
+enjoyment of the beautiful time and my own lazily blended thoughts.
+
+As to Dick, it was quite right to let him pull, for he was as strong
+as a horse, and had the greatest delight in bodily exercise, whatever
+it was. We really had some difficulty in getting him to stop when it
+was getting rather more than dusk, and the moon was brightening just
+as we were off Runnymede. We landed there, and were looking about
+for a place whereon to pitch our tents (for we had brought two with
+us), when an old man came up to us, bade us good evening, and asked
+if we were housed for that that night; and finding that we were not,
+bade us home to his house. Nothing loth, we went with him, and Clara
+took his hand in a coaxing way which I noticed she used with old men;
+and as we went on our way, made some commonplace remark about the
+beauty of the day. The old man stopped short, and looked at her and
+said: "You really like it then?"
+
+"Yes," she said, looking very much astonished, "Don't you?"
+
+"Well," said he, "perhaps I do. I did, at any rate, when I was
+younger; but now I think I should like it cooler."
+
+She said nothing, and went on, the night growing about as dark as it
+would be; till just at the rise of the hill we came to a hedge with a
+gate in it, which the old man unlatched and led us into a garden, at
+the end of which we could see a little house, one of whose little
+windows was already yellow with candlelight. We could see even under
+the doubtful light of the moon and the last of the western glow that
+the garden was stuffed full of flowers; and the fragrance it gave out
+in the gathering coolness was so wonderfully sweet, that it seemed
+the very heart of the delight of the June dusk; so that we three
+stopped instinctively, and Clara gave forth a little sweet "O," like
+a bird beginning to sing.
+
+"What's the matter?" said the old man, a little testily, and pulling
+at her hand. "There's no dog; or have you trodden on a thorn and
+hurt your foot?"
+
+"No, no, neighbour," she said; "but how sweet, how sweet it is!"
+
+"Of course it is," said he, "but do you care so much for that?"
+
+She laughed out musically, and we followed suit in our gruffer
+voices; and then she said: "Of course I do, neighbour; don't you?"
+
+"Well, I don't know," quoth the old fellow; then he added, as if
+somewhat ashamed of himself: "Besides, you know, when the waters are
+out and all Runnymede is flooded, it's none so pleasant."
+
+"_I_ should like it," quoth Dick. "What a jolly sail one would get
+about here on the floods on a bright frosty January morning!"
+
+"WOULD you like it?" said our host. "Well, I won't argue with you,
+neighbour; it isn't worth while. Come in and have some supper."
+
+We went up a paved path between the roses, and straight into a very
+pretty room, panelled and carved, and as clean as a new pin; but the
+chief ornament of which was a young woman, light-haired and grey-
+eyed, but with her face and hands and bare feet tanned quite brown
+with the sun. Though she was very lightly clad, that was clearly
+from choice, not from poverty, though these were the first cottage-
+dwellers I had come across; for her gown was of silk, and on her
+wrists were bracelets that seemed to me of great value. She was
+lying on a sheep-skin near the window, but jumped up as soon as we
+entered, and when she saw the guests behind the old man, she clapped
+her hands and cried out with pleasure, and when she got us into the
+middle of the room, fairly danced round us in delight of our company.
+
+"What!" said the old man, "you are pleased, are you, Ellen?"
+
+The girl danced up to him and threw her arms round him, and said:
+"Yes I am, and so ought you to be grandfather."
+
+"Well, well, I am," said he, "as much as I can be pleased. Guests,
+please be seated."
+
+This seemed rather strange to us; stranger, I suspect, to my friends
+than to me; but Dick took the opportunity of both the host and his
+grand-daughter being out of the room to say to me, softly: "A
+grumbler: there are a few of them still. Once upon a time, I am
+told, they were quite a nuisance."
+
+The old man came in as he spoke and sat down beside us with a sigh,
+which, indeed, seemed fetched up as if he wanted us to take notice of
+it; but just then the girl came in with the victuals, and the carle
+missed his mark, what between our hunger generally and that I was
+pretty busy watching the grand-daughter moving about as beautiful as
+a picture.
+
+Everything to eat and drink, though it was somewhat different to what
+we had had in London, was better than good, but the old man eyed
+rather sulkily the chief dish on the table, on which lay a leash of
+fine perch, and said:
+
+"H'm, perch! I am sorry we can't do better for you, guests. The
+time was when we might have had a good piece of salmon up from London
+for you; but the times have grown mean and petty."
+
+"Yes, but you might have had it now," said the girl, giggling, "if
+you had known that they were coming."
+
+"It's our fault for not bringing it with us, neighbours," said Dick,
+good-humouredly. "But if the times have grown petty, at any rate the
+perch haven't; that fellow in the middle there must have weighed a
+good two pounds when he was showing his dark stripes and red fins to
+the minnows yonder. And as to the salmon, why, neighbour, my friend
+here, who comes from the outlands, was quite surprised yesterday
+morning when I told him we had plenty of salmon at Hammersmith. I am
+sure I have heard nothing of the times worsening."
+
+He looked a little uncomfortable. And the old man, turning to me,
+said very courteously:
+
+"Well, sir, I am happy to see a man from over the water; but I really
+must appeal to you to say whether on the whole you are not better off
+in your country; where I suppose, from what our guest says, you are
+brisker and more alive, because you have not wholly got rid of
+competition. You see, I have read not a few books of the past days,
+and certainly THEY are much more alive than those which are written
+now; and good sound unlimited competition was the condition under
+which they were written,--if we didn't know that from the record of
+history, we should know it from the books themselves. There is a
+spirit of adventure in them, and signs of a capacity to extract good
+out of evil which our literature quite lacks now; and I cannot help
+thinking that our moralists and historians exaggerate hugely the
+unhappiness of the past days, in which such splendid works of
+imagination and intellect were produced."
+
+Clara listened to him with restless eyes, as if she were excited and
+pleased; Dick knitted his brow and looked still more uncomfortable,
+but said nothing. Indeed, the old man gradually, as he warmed to his
+subject, dropped his sneering manner, and both spoke and looked very
+seriously. But the girl broke out before I could deliver myself of
+the answer I was framing:
+
+"Books, books! always books, grandfather! When will you understand
+that after all it is the world we live in which interests us; the
+world of which we are a part, and which we can never love too much?
+Look!" she said, throwing open the casement wider and showing us the
+white light sparkling between the black shadows of the moonlit
+garden, through which ran a little shiver of the summer night-wind,
+"look! these are our books in these days!--and these," she said,
+stepping lightly up to the two lovers and laying a hand on each of
+their shoulders; "and the guest there, with his over-sea knowledge
+and experience;--yes, and even you, grandfather" (a smile ran over
+her face as she spoke), "with all your grumbling and wishing yourself
+back again in the good old days,--in which, as far as I can make out,
+a harmless and lazy old man like you would either have pretty nearly
+starved, or have had to pay soldiers and people to take the folk's
+victuals and clothes and houses away from them by force. Yes, these
+are our books; and if we want more, can we not find work to do in the
+beautiful buildings that we raise up all over the country (and I know
+there was nothing like them in past times), wherein a man can put
+forth whatever is in him, and make his hands set forth his mind and
+his soul."
+
+She paused a little, and I for my part could not help staring at her,
+and thinking that if she were a book, the pictures in it were most
+lovely. The colour mantled in her delicate sunburnt cheeks; her grey
+eyes, light amidst the tan of her face, kindly looked on us all as
+she spoke. She paused, and said again:
+
+"As for your books, they were well enough for times when intelligent
+people had but little else in which they could take pleasure, and
+when they must needs supplement the sordid miseries of their own
+lives with imaginations of the lives of other people. But I say
+flatly that in spite of all their cleverness and vigour, and capacity
+for story-telling, there is something loathsome about them. Some of
+them, indeed, do here and there show some feeling for those whom the
+history-books call 'poor,' and of the misery of whose lives we have
+some inkling; but presently they give it up, and towards the end of
+the story we must be contented to see the hero and heroine living
+happily in an island of bliss on other people's troubles; and that
+after a long series of sham troubles (or mostly sham) of their own
+making, illustrated by dreary introspective nonsense about their
+feelings and aspirations, and all the rest of it; while the world
+must even then have gone on its way, and dug and sewed and baked and
+built and carpentered round about these useless--animals."
+
+"There!" said the old man, reverting to his dry sulky manner again.
+"There's eloquence! I suppose you like it?"
+
+"Yes," said I, very emphatically.
+
+"Well," said he, "now the storm of eloquence has lulled for a little,
+suppose you answer my question?--that is, if you like, you know,"
+quoth he, with a sudden access of courtesy.
+
+"What question?" said I. For I must confess that Ellen's strange and
+almost wild beauty had put it out of my head.
+
+Said he: "First of all (excuse my catechising), is there competition
+in life, after the old kind, in the country whence you come?"
+
+"Yes," said I, "it is the rule there." And I wondered as I spoke
+what fresh complications I should get into as a result of this
+answer.
+
+"Question two," said the carle: "Are you not on the whole much
+freer, more energetic--in a word, healthier and happier--for it?"
+
+I smiled. "You wouldn't talk so if you had any idea of our life. To
+me you seem here as if you were living in heaven compared with us of
+the country from which I came."
+
+"Heaven?" said he: "you like heaven, do you?"
+
+"Yes," said I--snappishly, I am afraid; for I was beginning rather to
+resent his formula.
+
+"Well, I am far from sure that I do," quoth he. "I think one may do
+more with one's life than sitting on a damp cloud and singing hymns."
+
+I was rather nettled by this inconsequence, and said: "Well,
+neighbour, to be short, and without using metaphors, in the land
+whence I come, where the competition which produced those literary
+works which you admire so much is still the rule, most people are
+thoroughly unhappy; here, to me at least most people seem thoroughly
+happy."
+
+"No offence, guest--no offence," said he; "but let me ask you; you
+like that, do you?"
+
+His formula, put with such obstinate persistence, made us all laugh
+heartily; and even the old man joined in the laughter on the sly.
+However, he was by no means beaten, and said presently:
+
+"From all I can hear, I should judge that a young woman so beautiful
+as my dear Ellen yonder would have been a lady, as they called it in
+the old time, and wouldn't have had to wear a few rags of silk as she
+does now, or to have browned herself in the sun as she has to do now.
+What do you say to that, eh?"
+
+Here Clara, who had been pretty much silent hitherto, struck in, and
+said: "Well, really, I don't think that you would have mended
+matters, or that they want mending. Don't you see that she is
+dressed deliciously for this beautiful weather? And as for the sun-
+burning of your hay-fields, why, I hope to pick up some of that for
+myself when we get a little higher up the river. Look if I don't
+need a little sun on my pasty white skin!"
+
+And she stripped up the sleeve from her arm and laid it beside
+Ellen's who was now sitting next her. To say the truth, it was
+rather amusing to me to see Clara putting herself forward as a town-
+bred fine lady, for she was as well-knit and clean-skinned a girl as
+might be met with anywhere at the best. Dick stroked the beautiful
+arm rather shyly, and pulled down the sleeve again, while she blushed
+at his touch; and the old man said laughingly: "Well, I suppose you
+DO like that; don't you?"
+
+Ellen kissed her new friend, and we all sat silent for a little, till
+she broke out into a sweet shrill song, and held us all entranced
+with the wonder of her clear voice; and the old grumbler sat looking
+at her lovingly. The other young people sang also in due time; and
+then Ellen showed us to our beds in small cottage chambers, fragrant
+and clean as the ideal of the old pastoral poets; and the pleasure of
+the evening quite extinguished my fear of the last night, that I
+should wake up in the old miserable world of worn-out pleasures, and
+hopes that were half fears.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII: AN EARLY MORNING BY RUNNYMEDE
+
+
+
+Though there were no rough noises to wake me, I could not lie long
+abed the next morning, where the world seemed so well awake, and,
+despite the old grumbler, so happy; so I got up, and found that,
+early as it was, someone had been stirring, since all was trim and in
+its place in the little parlour, and the table laid for the morning
+meal. Nobody was afoot in the house as then, however, so I went out
+a-doors, and after a turn or two round the superabundant garden, I
+wandered down over the meadow to the river-side, where lay our boat,
+looking quite familiar and friendly to me. I walked up stream a
+little, watching the light mist curling up from the river till the
+sun gained power to draw it all away; saw the bleak speckling the
+water under the willow boughs, whence the tiny flies they fed on were
+falling in myriads; heard the great chub splashing here and there at
+some belated moth or other, and felt almost back again in my boyhood.
+Then I went back again to the boat, and loitered there a minute or
+two, and then walked slowly up the meadow towards the little house.
+I noted now that there were four more houses of about the same size
+on the slope away from the river. The meadow in which I was going
+was not up for hay; but a row of flake-hurdles ran up the slope not
+far from me on each side, and in the field so parted off from ours on
+the left they were making hay busily by now, in the simple fashion of
+the days when I was a boy. My feet turned that way instinctively, as
+I wanted to see how haymakers looked in these new and better times,
+and also I rather expected to see Ellen there. I came to the hurdles
+and stood looking over into the hay-field, and was close to the end
+of the long line of haymakers who were spreading the low ridges to
+dry off the night dew. The majority of these were young women clad
+much like Ellen last night, though not mostly in silk, but in light
+woollen mostly gaily embroidered; the men being all clad in white
+flannel embroidered in bright colours. The meadow looked like a
+gigantic tulip-bed because of them. All hands were working
+deliberately but well and steadily, though they were as noisy with
+merry talk as a grove of autumn starlings. Half a dozen of them, men
+and women, came up to me and shook hands, gave me the sele of the
+morning, and asked a few questions as to whence and whither, and
+wishing me good luck, went back to their work. Ellen, to my
+disappointment, was not amongst them, but presently I saw a light
+figure come out of the hay-field higher up the slope, and make for
+our house; and that was Ellen, holding a basket in her hand. But
+before she had come to the garden gate, out came Dick and Clara, who,
+after a minute's pause, came down to meet me, leaving Ellen in the
+garden; then we three went down to the boat, talking mere morning
+prattle. We stayed there a little, Dick arranging some of the
+matters in her, for we had only taken up to the house such things as
+we thought the dew might damage; and then we went toward the house
+again; but when we came near the garden, Dick stopped us by laying a
+hand on my arm and said, -
+
+"Just look a moment."
+
+I looked, and over the low hedge saw Ellen, shading her eyes against
+the sun as she looked toward the hay-field, a light wind stirring in
+her tawny hair, her eyes like light jewels amidst her sunburnt face,
+which looked as if the warmth of the sun were yet in it.
+
+"Look, guest," said Dick; "doesn't it all look like one of those very
+stories out of Grimm that we were talking about up in Bloomsbury?
+Here are we two lovers wandering about the world, and we have come to
+a fairy garden, and there is the very fairy herself amidst of it: I
+wonder what she will do for us."
+
+Said Clara demurely, but not stiffly: "Is she a good fairy, Dick?"
+
+"O, yes," said he; "and according to the card, she would do better,
+if it were not for the gnome or wood-spirit, our grumbling friend of
+last night."
+
+We laughed at this; and I said, "I hope you see that you have left me
+out of the tale."
+
+"Well," said he, "that's true. You had better consider that you have
+got the cap of darkness, and are seeing everything, yourself
+invisible."
+
+That touched me on my weak side of not feeling sure of my position in
+this beautiful new country; so in order not to make matters worse, I
+held my tongue, and we all went into the garden and up to the house
+together. I noticed by the way that Clara must really rather have
+felt the contrast between herself as a town madam and this piece of
+the summer country that we all admired so, for she had rather dressed
+after Ellen that morning as to thinness and scantiness, and went
+barefoot also, except for light sandals.
+
+The old man greeted us kindly in the parlour, and said: "Well,
+guests, so you have been looking about to search into the nakedness
+of the land: I suppose your illusions of last night have given way a
+bit before the morning light? Do you still like, it, eh?"
+
+"Very much," said I, doggedly; "it is one of the prettiest places on
+the lower Thames."
+
+"Oho!" said he; "so you know the Thames, do you?"
+
+I reddened, for I saw Dick and Clara looking at me, and scarcely knew
+what to say. However, since I had said in our early intercourse with
+my Hammersmith friends that I had known Epping Forest, I thought a
+hasty generalisation might be better in avoiding complications than a
+downright lie; so I said -
+
+"I have been in this country before; and I have been on the Thames in
+those days."
+
+"O," said the old man, eagerly, "so you have been in this country
+before. Now really, don't you FIND it (apart from all theory, you
+know) much changed for the worse?"
+
+"No, not at all," said I; "I find it much changed for the better."
+
+"Ah," quoth he, "I fear that you have been prejudiced by some theory
+or another. However, of course the time when you were here before
+must have been so near our own days that the deterioration might not
+be very great: as then we were, of course, still living under the
+same customs as we are now. I was thinking of earlier days than
+that."
+
+"In short," said Clara, "you have THEORIES about the change which has
+taken place."
+
+"I have facts as well," said he. "Look here! from this hill you can
+see just four little houses, including this one. Well, I know for
+certain that in old times, even in the summer, when the leaves were
+thickest, you could see from the same place six quite big and fine
+houses; and higher up the water, garden joined garden right up to
+Windsor; and there were big houses in all the gardens. Ah! England
+was an important place in those days."
+
+I was getting nettled, and said: "What you mean is that you de-
+cockneyised the place, and sent the damned flunkies packing, and that
+everybody can live comfortably and happily, and not a few damned
+thieves only, who were centres of vulgarity and corruption wherever
+they were, and who, as to this lovely river, destroyed its beauty
+morally, and had almost destroyed it physically, when they were
+thrown out of it."
+
+There was silence after this outburst, which for the life of me I
+could not help, remembering how I had suffered from cockneyism and
+its cause on those same waters of old time. But at last the old man
+said, quite coolly:
+
+"My dear guest, I really don't know what you mean by either cockneys,
+or flunkies, or thieves, or damned; or how only a few people could
+live happily and comfortably in a wealthy country. All I can see is
+that you are angry, and I fear with me: so if you like we will
+change the subject."
+
+I thought this kind and hospitable in him, considering his obstinacy
+about his theory; and hastened to say that I did not mean to be
+angry, only emphatic. He bowed gravely, and I thought the storm was
+over, when suddenly Ellen broke in:
+
+"Grandfather, our guest is reticent from courtesy; but really what he
+has in his mind to say to you ought to be said; so as I know pretty
+well what it is, I will say it for him: for as you know, I have been
+taught these things by people who--"
+
+"Yes," said the old man, "by the sage of Bloomsbury, and others."
+
+"O," said Dick, "so you know my old kinsman Hammond?"
+
+"Yes," said she, "and other people too, as my grandfather says, and
+they have taught me things: and this is the upshot of it. We live
+in a little house now, not because we have nothing grander to do than
+working in the fields, but because we please; for if we liked, we
+could go and live in a big house amongst pleasant companions."
+
+Grumbled the old man: "Just so! As if I would live amongst those
+conceited fellows; all of them looking down upon me!"
+
+She smiled on him kindly, but went on as if he had not spoken. "In
+the past times, when those big houses of which grandfather speaks
+were so plenty, we MUST have lived in a cottage whether we had liked
+it or not; and the said cottage, instead of having in it everything
+we want, would have been bare and empty. We should not have got
+enough to eat; our clothes would have been ugly to look at, dirty and
+frowsy. You, grandfather, have done no hard work for years now, but
+wander about and read your books and have nothing to worry you; and
+as for me, I work hard when I like it, because I like it, and think
+it does me good, and knits up my muscles, and makes me prettier to
+look at, and healthier and happier. But in those past days you,
+grandfather, would have had to work hard after you were old; and
+would have been always afraid of having to be shut up in a kind of
+prison along with other old men, half-starved and without amusement.
+And as for me, I am twenty years old. In those days my middle age
+would be beginning now, and in a few years I should be pinched, thin,
+and haggard, beset with troubles and miseries, so that no one could
+have guessed that I was once a beautiful girl.
+
+"Is this what you have had in your mind, guest?" said she, the tears
+in her eyes at thought of the past miseries of people like herself.
+
+"Yes," said I, much moved; "that and more. Often--in my country I
+have seen that wretched change you have spoken of, from the fresh
+handsome country lass to the poor draggle-tailed country woman."
+
+The old man sat silent for a little, but presently recovered himself
+and took comfort in his old phrase of "Well, you like it so, do you?"
+
+"Yes," said Ellen, "I love life better than death."
+
+"O, you do, do you?" said he. "Well, for my part I like reading a
+good old book with plenty of fun in it, like Thackeray's 'Vanity
+Fair.' Why don't you write books like that now? Ask that question
+of your Bloomsbury sage."
+
+Seeing Dick's cheeks reddening a little at this sally, and noting
+that silence followed, I thought I had better do something. So I
+said: "I am only the guest, friends; but I know you want to show me
+your river at its best, so don't you think we had better be moving
+presently, as it is certainly going to be a hot day?"
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV: UP THE THAMES: THE SECOND DAY
+
+
+
+They were not slow to take my hint; and indeed, as to the mere time
+of day, it was best for us to be off, as it was past seven o'clock,
+and the day promised to be very hot. So we got up and went down to
+our boat--Ellen thoughtful and abstracted; the old man very kind and
+courteous, as if to make up for his crabbedness of opinion. Clara
+was cheerful and natural, but a little subdued, I thought; and she at
+least was not sorry to be gone, and often looked shyly and timidly at
+Ellen and her strange wild beauty. So we got into the boat, Dick
+saying as he took his place, "Well, it IS a fine day!" and the old
+man answering "What! you like that, do you?" once more; and presently
+Dick was sending the bows swiftly through the slow weed-checked
+stream. I turned round as we got into mid-stream, and waving my hand
+to our hosts, saw Ellen leaning on the old man's shoulder, and
+caressing his healthy apple-red cheek, and quite a keen pang smote me
+as I thought how I should never see the beautiful girl again.
+Presently I insisted on taking the sculls, and I rowed a good deal
+that day; which no doubt accounts for the fact that we got very late
+to the place which Dick had aimed at. Clara was particularly
+affectionate to Dick, as I noticed from the rowing thwart; but as for
+him, he was as frankly kind and merry as ever; and I was glad to see
+it, as a man of his temperament could not have taken her caresses
+cheerfully and without embarrassment if he had been at all entangled
+by the fairy of our last night's abode.
+
+I need say little about the lovely reaches of the river here. I duly
+noted that absence of cockney villas which the old man had lamented;
+and I saw with pleasure that my old enemies the "Gothic" cast-iron
+bridges had been replaced by handsome oak and stone ones. Also the
+banks of the forest that we passed through had lost their courtly
+game-keeperish trimness, and were as wild and beautiful as need he,
+though the trees were clearly well seen to. I thought it best, in
+order to get the most direct information, to play the innocent about
+Eton and Windsor; but Dick volunteered his knowledge to me as we lay
+in Datchet lock about the first. Quoth he:
+
+"Up yonder are some beautiful old buildings, which were built for a
+great college or teaching-place by one of the mediaeval kings--Edward
+the Sixth, I think" (I smiled to myself at his rather natural
+blunder). "He meant poor people's sons to be taught there what
+knowledge was going in his days; but it was a matter of course that
+in the times of which you seem to know so much they spoilt whatever
+good there was in the founder's intentions. My old kinsman says that
+they treated them in a very simple way, and instead of teaching poor
+men's sons to know something, they taught rich men's sons to know
+nothing. It seems from what he says that it was a place for the
+'aristocracy' (if you know what that word means; I have been told its
+meaning) to get rid of the company of their male children for a great
+part of the year. I daresay old Hammond would give you plenty of
+information in detail about it."
+
+"What is it used for now?" said I.
+
+"Well," said he, "the buildings were a good deal spoilt by the last
+few generations of aristocrats, who seem to have had a great hatred
+against beautiful old buildings, and indeed all records of past
+history; but it is still a delightful place. Of course, we cannot
+use it quite as the founder intended, since our ideas about teaching
+young people are so changed from the ideas of his time; so it is used
+now as a dwelling for people engaged in learning; and folk from round
+about come and get taught things that they want to learn; and there
+is a great library there of the best books. So that I don't think
+that the old dead king would be much hurt if he were to come to life
+and see what we are doing there."
+
+"Well," said Clara, laughing, "I think he would miss the boys."
+
+"Not always, my dear," said Dick, "for there are often plenty of boys
+there, who come to get taught; and also," said he, smiling, "to learn
+boating and swimming. I wish we could stop there: but perhaps we
+had better do that coming down the water."
+
+The lock-gates opened as he spoke, and out we went, and on. And as
+for Windsor, he said nothing till I lay on my oars (for I was
+sculling then) in Clewer reach, and looking up, said, "What is all
+that building up there?"
+
+Said he: "There, I thought I would wait till you asked, yourself.
+That is Windsor Castle: that also I thought I would keep for you
+till we come down the water. It looks fine from here, doesn't it?
+But a great deal of it has been built or skinned in the time of the
+Degradation, and we wouldn't pull the buildings down, since they were
+there; just as with the buildings of the Dung-Market. You know, of
+course, that it was the palace of our old mediaeval kings, and was
+used later on for the same purpose by the parliamentary commercial
+sham-kings, as my old kinsman calls them.''
+
+"Yes," said I, "I know all that. What is it used for now?"
+
+"A great many people live there," said he, "as, with all drawbacks,
+it is a pleasant place; there is also a well-arranged store of
+antiquities of various kinds that have seemed worth keeping--a
+museum, it would have been called in the times you understand so
+well."
+
+I drew my sculls through the water at that last word, and pulled as
+if I were fleeing from those times which I understood so well; and we
+were soon going up the once sorely be-cockneyed reaches of the river
+about Maidenhead, which now looked as pleasant and enjoyable as the
+up-river reaches.
+
+The morning was now getting on, the morning of a jewel of a summer
+day; one of those days which, if they were commoner in these islands,
+would make our climate the best of all climates, without dispute. A
+light wind blew from the west; the little clouds that had arisen at
+about our breakfast time had seemed to get higher and higher in the
+heavens; and in spite of the burning sun we no more longed for rain
+than we feared it. Burning as the sun was, there was a fresh feeling
+in the air that almost set us a-longing for the rest of the hot
+afternoon, and the stretch of blossoming wheat seen from the shadow
+of the boughs. No one unburdened with very heavy anxieties could
+have felt otherwise than happy that morning: and it must be said
+that whatever anxieties might lie beneath the surface of things, we
+didn't seem to come across any of them.
+
+We passed by several fields where haymaking was going on, but Dick,
+and especially Clara, were so jealous of our up-river festival that
+they would not allow me to have much to say to them. I could only
+notice that the people in the fields looked strong and handsome, both
+men and women, and that so far from there being any appearance of
+sordidness about their attire, they seemed to be dressed specially
+for the occasion,--lightly, of course, but gaily and with plenty of
+adornment.
+
+Both on this day as well as yesterday we had, as you may think, met
+and passed and been passed by many craft of one kind and another.
+The most part of these were being rowed like ourselves, or were
+sailing, in the sort of way that sailing is managed on the upper
+reaches of the river; but every now and then we came on barges, laden
+with hay or other country produce, or carrying bricks, lime, timber,
+and the like, and these were going on their way without any means of
+propulsion visible to me--just a man at the tiller, with often a
+friend or two laughing and talking with him. Dick, seeing on one
+occasion this day, that I was looking rather hard on one of these,
+said: "That is one of our force-barges; it is quite as easy to work
+vehicles by force by water as by land."
+
+I understood pretty well that these "force vehicles" had taken the
+place of our old steam-power carrying; but I took good care not to
+ask any questions about them, as I knew well enough both that I
+should never be able to understand how they were worked, and that in
+attempting to do so I should betray myself, or get into some
+complication impossible to explain; so I merely said, "Yes, of
+course, I understand."
+
+We went ashore at Bisham, where the remains of the old Abbey and the
+Elizabethan house that had been added to them yet remained, none the
+worse for many years of careful and appreciative habitation. The
+folk of the place, however, were mostly in the fields that day, both
+men and women; so we met only two old men there, and a younger one
+who had stayed at home to get on with some literary work, which I
+imagine we considerably interrupted. Yet I also think that the hard-
+working man who received us was not very sorry for the interruption.
+Anyhow, he kept on pressing us to stay over and over again, till at
+last we did not get away till the cool of the evening.
+
+However, that mattered little to us; the nights were light, for the
+moon was shining in her third quarter, and it was all one to Dick
+whether he sculled or sat quiet in the boat: so we went away a great
+pace. The evening sun shone bright on the remains of the old
+buildings at Medmenham; close beside which arose an irregular pile of
+building which Dick told us was a very pleasant house; and there were
+plenty of houses visible on the wide meadows opposite, under the
+hill; for, as it seems that the beauty of Hurley had compelled people
+to build and live there a good deal. The sun very low down showed us
+Henley little altered in outward aspect from what I remembered it.
+Actual daylight failed us as we passed through the lovely reaches of
+Wargrave and Shiplake; but the moon rose behind us presently. I
+should like to have seen with my eyes what success the new order of
+things had had in getting rid of the sprawling mess with which
+commercialism had littered the banks of the wide stream about Reading
+and Caversham: certainly everything smelt too deliciously in the
+early night for there to be any of the old careless sordidness of so-
+called manufacture; and in answer to my question as to what sort of a
+place Reading was, Dick answered:
+
+"O, a nice town enough in its way; mostly rebuilt within the last
+hundred years; and there are a good many houses, as you can see by
+the lights just down under the hills yonder. In fact, it is one of
+the most populous places on the Thames round about here. Keep up
+your spirits, guest! we are close to our journey's end for the night.
+I ought to ask your pardon for not stopping at one of the houses here
+or higher up; but a friend, who is living in a very pleasant house in
+the Maple-Durham meads, particularly wanted me and Clara to come and
+see him on our way up the Thames; and I thought you wouldn't mind
+this bit of night travelling."
+
+He need not have adjured me to keep up my spirits, which were as high
+as possible; though the strangeness and excitement of the happy and
+quiet life which I saw everywhere around me was, it is true, a little
+wearing off, yet a deep content, as different as possible from
+languid acquiescence, was taking its place, and I was, as it were,
+really new-born.
+
+We landed presently just where I remembered the river making an elbow
+to the north towards the ancient house of the Blunts; with the wide
+meadows spreading on the right-hand side, and on the left the long
+line of beautiful old trees overhanging the water. As we got out of
+the boat, I said to Dick -
+
+"Is it the old house we are going to?"
+
+"No," he said, "though that is standing still in green old age, and
+is well inhabited. I see, by the way, that you know your Thames
+well. But my friend Walter Allen, who asked me to stop here, lives
+in a house, not very big, which has been built here lately, because
+these meadows are so much liked, especially in summer, that there was
+getting to be rather too much of tenting on the open field; so the
+parishes here about, who rather objected to that, built three houses
+between this and Caversham, and quite a large one at Basildon, a
+little higher up. Look, yonder are the lights of Walter Allen's
+house!"
+
+So we walked over the grass of the meadows under a flood of
+moonlight, and soon came to the house, which was low and built round
+a quadrangle big enough to get plenty of sunshine in it. Walter
+Allen, Dick's friend, was leaning against the jamb of the doorway
+waiting for us, and took us into the hall without overplus of words.
+There were not many people in it, as some of the dwellers there were
+away at the haymaking in the neighbourhood, and some, as Walter told
+us, were wandering about the meadow enjoying the beautiful moonlit
+night. Dick's friend looked to be a man of about forty; tall, black-
+haired, very kind-looking and thoughtful; but rather to my surprise
+there was a shade of melancholy on his face, and he seemed a little
+abstracted and inattentive to our chat, in spite of obvious efforts
+to listen.
+
+Dick looked on him from time to time, and seemed troubled; and at
+last he said: "I say, old fellow, if there is anything the matter
+which we didn't know of when you wrote to me, don't you think you had
+better tell us about it at once? Or else we shall think we have come
+here at an unlucky time, and are not quite wanted."
+
+Walter turned red, and seemed to have some difficulty in restraining
+his tears, but said at last: "Of course everybody here is very glad
+to see you, Dick, and your friends; but it is true that we are not at
+our best, in spite of the fine weather and the glorious hay-crop. We
+have had a death here."
+
+Said Dick: "Well, you should get over that, neighbour: such things
+must be."
+
+"Yes," Walter said, "but this was a death by violence, and it seems
+likely to lead to at least one more; and somehow it makes us feel
+rather shy of one another; and to say the truth, that is one reason
+why there are so few of us present to-night."
+
+"Tell us the story, Walter," said Dick; "perhaps telling it will help
+you to shake off your sadness."
+
+Said Walter: "Well, I will; and I will make it short enough, though
+I daresay it might be spun out into a long one, as used to be done
+with such subjects in the old novels. There is a very charming girl
+here whom we all like, and whom some of us do more than like; and she
+very naturally liked one of us better than anybody else. And another
+of us (I won't name him) got fairly bitten with love-madness, and
+used to go about making himself as unpleasant as he could--not of
+malice prepense, of course; so that the girl, who liked him well
+enough at first, though she didn't love him, began fairly to dislike
+him. Of course, those of us who knew him best--myself amongst
+others--advised him to go away, as he was making matters worse and
+worse for himself every day. Well, he wouldn't take our advice (that
+also, I suppose, was a matter of course), so we had to tell him that
+he MUST go, or the inevitable sending to Coventry would follow; for
+his individual trouble had so overmastered him that we felt that WE
+must go if he did not.
+
+"He took that better than we expected, when something or other--an
+interview with the girl, I think, and some hot words with the
+successful lover following close upon it, threw him quite off his
+balance; and he got hold of an axe and fell upon his rival when there
+was no one by; and in the struggle that followed the man attacked,
+hit him an unlucky blow and killed him. And now the slayer in his
+turn is so upset that he is like to kill himself; and if he does, the
+girl will do as much, I fear. And all this we could no more help
+than the earthquake of the year before last."
+
+"It is very unhappy," said Dick; "but since the man is dead, and
+cannot be brought to life again, and since the slayer had no malice
+in him, I cannot for the life of me see why he shouldn't get over it
+before long. Besides, it was the right man that was killed and not
+the wrong. Why should a man brood over a mere accident for ever?
+And the girl?"
+
+"As to her," said Walter, "the whole thing seems to have inspired her
+with terror rather than grief. What you say about the man is true,
+or it should be; but then, you see, the excitement and jealousy that
+was the prelude to this tragedy had made an evil and feverish element
+round about him, from which he does not seem to be able to escape.
+However, we have advised him to go away--in fact, to cross the seas;
+but he is in such a state that I do not think he CAN go unless
+someone TAKES him, and I think it will fall to my lot to do so; which
+is scarcely a cheerful outlook for me."
+
+"O, you will find a certain kind of interest in it," said Dick. "And
+of course he MUST soon look upon the affair from a reasonable point
+of view sooner or later."
+
+"Well, at any rate," quoth Walter, "now that I have eased my mind by
+making you uncomfortable, let us have an end of the subject for the
+present. Are you going to take your guest to Oxford?"
+
+"Why, of course we must pass through it," said Dick, smiling, "as we
+are going into the upper waters: but I thought that we wouldn't stop
+there, or we shall be belated as to the haymaking up our way. So
+Oxford and my learned lecture on it, all got at second-hand from my
+old kinsman, must wait till we come down the water a fortnight
+hence."
+
+I listened to this story with much surprise, and could not help
+wondering at first that the man who had slain the other had not been
+put in custody till it could be proved that he killed his rival in
+self-defence only. However, the more I thought of it, the plainer it
+grew to me that no amount of examination of witnesses, who had
+witnessed nothing but the ill-blood between the two rivals, would
+have done anything to clear up the case. I could not help thinking,
+also, that the remorse of this homicide gave point to what old
+Hammond had said to me about the way in which this strange people
+dealt with what I had been used to hear called crimes. Truly, the
+remorse was exaggerated; but it was quite clear that the slayer took
+the whole consequences of the act upon himself, and did not expect
+society to whitewash him by punishing him. I had no fear any longer
+that "the sacredness of human life" was likely to suffer amongst my
+friends from the absence of gallows and prison.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV: THE THIRD DAY ON THE THAMES
+
+
+
+As we went down to the boat next morning, Walter could not quite keep
+off the subject of last night, though he was more hopeful than he had
+been then, and seemed to think that if the unlucky homicide could not
+be got to go over-sea, he might at any rate go and live somewhere in
+the neighbourhood pretty much by himself; at any rate, that was what
+he himself had proposed. To Dick, and I must say to me also, this
+seemed a strange remedy; and Dick said as much. Quoth he:
+
+"Friend Walter, don't set the man brooding on the tragedy by letting
+him live alone. That will only strengthen his idea that he has
+committed a crime, and you will have him killing himself in good
+earnest."
+
+Said Clara: "I don't know. If I may say what I think of it, it is
+that he had better have his fill of gloom now, and, so to say, wake
+up presently to see how little need there has been for it; and then
+he will live happily afterwards. As for his killing himself, you
+need not be afraid of that; for, from all you tell me, he is really
+very much in love with the woman; and to speak plainly, until his
+love is satisfied, he will not only stick to life as tightly as he
+can, but will also make the most of every event of his life--will, so
+to say, hug himself up in it; and I think that this is the real
+explanation of his taking the whole matter with such an excess of
+tragedy."
+
+Walter looked thoughtful, and said: "Well, you may be right; and
+perhaps we should have treated it all more lightly: but you see,
+guest" (turning to me), "such things happen so seldom, that when they
+do happen, we cannot help being much taken up with it. For the rest,
+we are all inclined, to excuse our poor friend for making us so
+unhappy, on the ground that he does it out of an exaggerated respect
+for human life and its happiness. Well, I will say no more about it;
+only this: will you give me a cast up stream, as I want to look
+after a lonely habitation for the poor fellow, since he will have it
+so, and I hear that there is one which would suit us very well on the
+downs beyond Streatley; so if you will put me ashore there I will
+walk up the hill and look to it."
+
+"Is the house in question empty?" said I.
+
+"No," said Walter, "but the man who lives there will go out of it, of
+course, when he hears that we want it. You see, we think that the
+fresh air of the downs and the very emptiness of the landscape will
+do our friend good."
+
+"Yes," said Clara, smiling, "and he will not be so far from his
+beloved that they cannot easily meet if they have a mind to--as they
+certainly will."
+
+This talk had brought us down to the boat, and we were presently
+afloat on the beautiful broad stream, Dick driving the prow swiftly
+through the windless water of the early summer morning, for it was
+not yet six o'clock. We were at the lock in a very little time; and
+as we lay rising and rising on the in-coming water, I could not help
+wondering that my old friend the pound-lock, and that of the very
+simplest and most rural kind, should hold its place there; so I said:
+
+"I have been wondering, as we passed lock after lock, that you
+people, so prosperous as you are, and especially since you are so
+anxious for pleasant work to do, have not invented something which
+would get rid of this clumsy business of going up-stairs by means of
+these rude contrivances."
+
+Dick laughed. "My dear friend," said he, "as long as water has the
+clumsy habit of running down hill, I fear we must humour it by going
+up-stairs when we have our faces turned from the sea. And really I
+don't see why you should fall foul of Maple-Durham lock, which I
+think a very pretty place."
+
+There was no doubt about the latter assertion, I thought, as I looked
+up at the overhanging boughs of the great trees, with the sun coming
+glittering through the leaves, and listened to the song of the summer
+blackbirds as it mingled with the sound of the backwater near us. So
+not being able to say why I wanted the locks away--which, indeed, I
+didn't do at all--I held my peace. But Walter said -
+
+"You see, guest, this is not an age of inventions. The last epoch
+did all that for us, and we are now content to use such of its
+inventions as we find handy, and leaving those alone which we don't
+want. I believe, as a matter of fact, that some time ago (I can't
+give you a date) some elaborate machinery was used for the locks,
+though people did not go so far as try to make the water run up hill.
+However, it was troublesome, I suppose, and the simple hatches, and
+the gates, with a big counterpoising beam, were found to answer every
+purpose, and were easily mended when wanted with material always to
+hand: so here they are, as you see."
+
+"Besides," said Dick, "this kind of lock is pretty, as you can see;
+and I can't help thinking that your machine-lock, winding up like a
+watch, would have been ugly and would have spoiled the look of the
+river: and that is surely reason enough for keeping such locks as
+these. Good-bye, old fellow!" said he to the lock, as he pushed us
+out through the now open gates by a vigorous stroke of the boat-hook.
+"May you live long, and have your green old age renewed for ever!"
+
+On we went; and the water had the familiar aspect to me of the days
+before Pangbourne had been thoroughly cocknified, as I have seen it.
+It (Pangbourne) was distinctly a village still--i.e., a definite
+group of houses, and as pretty as might be. The beech-woods still
+covered the hill that rose above Basildon; but the flat fields
+beneath them were much more populous than I remembered them, as there
+were five large houses in sight, very carefully designed so as not to
+hurt the character of the country. Down on the green lip of the
+river, just where the water turns toward the Goring and Streatley
+reaches, were half a dozen girls playing about on the grass. They
+hailed us as we were about passing them, as they noted that we were
+travellers, and we stopped a minute to talk with them. They had been
+bathing, and were light clad and bare-footed, and were bound for the
+meadows on the Berkshire side, where the haymaking had begun, and
+were passing the time merrily enough till the Berkshire folk came in
+their punt to fetch them. At first nothing would content them but we
+must go with them into the hay-field, and breakfast with them; but
+Dick put forward his theory of beginning the hay-harvest higher up
+the water, and not spoiling my pleasure therein by giving me a taste
+of it elsewhere, and they gave way, though unwillingly. In revenge
+they asked me a great many questions about the country I came from
+and the manners of life there, which I found rather puzzling to
+answer; and doubtless what answers I did give were puzzling enough to
+them. I noticed both with these pretty girls and with everybody else
+we met, that in default of serious news, such as we had heard at
+Maple-Durham, they were eager to discuss all the little details of
+life: the weather, the hay-crop, the last new house, the plenty or
+lack of such and such birds, and so on; and they talked of these
+things not in a fatuous and conventional way, but as taking, I say,
+real interest in them. Moreover, I found that the women knew as much
+about all these things as the men: could name a flower, and knew its
+qualities; could tell you the habitat of such and such birds and
+fish, and the like.
+
+It is almost strange what a difference this intelligence made in my
+estimate of the country life of that day; for it used to be said in
+past times, and on the whole truly, that outside their daily work
+country people knew little of the country, and at least could tell
+you nothing about it; while here were these people as eager about all
+the goings on in the fields and woods and downs as if they had been
+Cockneys newly escaped from the tyranny of bricks and mortar.
+
+I may mention as a detail worth noticing that not only did there seem
+to be a great many more birds about of the non-predatory kinds, but
+their enemies the birds of prey were also commoner. A kite hung over
+our heads as we passed Medmenham yesterday; magpies were quite common
+in the hedgerows; I saw several sparrow-hawks, and I think a merlin;
+and now just as we were passing the pretty bridge which had taken the
+place of Basildon railway-bridge, a couple of ravens croaked above
+our boat, as they sailed off to the higher ground of the downs. I
+concluded from all this that the days of the gamekeeper were over,
+and did not even need to ask Dick a question about it.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI: THE OBSTINATE REFUSERS
+
+
+
+Before we parted from these girls we saw two sturdy young men and a
+woman putting off from the Berkshire shore, and then Dick bethought
+him of a little banter of the girls, and asked them how it was that
+there was nobody of the male kind to go with them across the water,
+and where their boats were gone to. Said one, the youngest of the
+party: "O, they have got the big punt to lead stone from up the
+water."
+
+"Who do you mean by 'they,' dear child?" said Dick.
+
+Said an older girl, laughing: "You had better go and see them. Look
+there," and she pointed northwest, "don't you see building going on
+there?"
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "and I am rather surprised at this time of the
+year; why are they not haymaking with you?"
+
+The girls all laughed at this, and before their laugh was over, the
+Berkshire boat had run on to the grass and the girls stepped in
+lightly, still sniggering, while the new comers gave us the sele of
+the day. But before they were under way again, the tall girl said:
+
+"Excuse us for laughing, dear neighbours, but we have had some
+friendly bickering with the builders up yonder, and as we have no
+time to tell you the story, you had better go and ask them: they
+will be glad to see you--if you don't hinder their work."
+
+They all laughed again at that, and waved us a pretty farewell as the
+punters set them over toward the other shore, and left us standing on
+the bank beside our boat.
+
+"Let us go and see them," said Clara; "that is, if you are not in a
+hurry to get to Streatley, Walter?"
+
+"O no," said Walter, "I shall be glad of the excuse to have a little
+more of your company."
+
+So we left the boat moored there, and went on up the slow slope of
+the hill; but I said to Dick on the way, being somewhat mystified:
+"What was all that laughing about? what was the joke!"
+
+"I can guess pretty well," said Dick; "some of them up there have got
+a piece of work which interests them, and they won't go to the
+haymaking, which doesn't matter at all, because there are plenty of
+people to do such easy-hard work as that; only, since haymaking is a
+regular festival, the neighbours find it amusing to jeer good-
+humouredly at them."
+
+"I see," said I, "much as if in Dickens's time some young people were
+so wrapped up in their work that they wouldn't keep Christmas."
+
+"Just so," said Dick, "only these people need not be young either."
+
+"But what did you mean by easy-hard work?" said I.
+
+Quoth Dick: "Did I say that? I mean work that tries the muscles and
+hardens them and sends you pleasantly weary to bed, but which isn't
+trying in other ways: doesn't harass you in short. Such work is
+always pleasant if you don't overdo it. Only, mind you, good mowing
+requires some little skill. I'm a pretty good mower."
+
+This talk brought us up to the house that was a-building, not a large
+one, which stood at the end of a beautiful orchard surrounded by an
+old stone wall. "O yes, I see," said Dick; "I remember, a beautiful
+place for a house: but a starveling of a nineteenth century house
+stood there: I am glad they are rebuilding: it's all stone, too,
+though it need not have been in this part of the country: my word,
+though, they are making a neat job of it: but I wouldn't have made
+it all ashlar."
+
+Walter and Clara were already talking to a tall man clad in his
+mason's blouse, who looked about forty, but was I daresay older, who
+had his mallet and chisel in hand; there were at work in the shed and
+on the scaffold about half a dozen men and two women, blouse-clad
+like the carles, while a very pretty woman who was not in the work
+but was dressed in an elegant suit of blue linen came sauntering up
+to us with her knitting in her hand. She welcomed us and said,
+smiling: "So you are come up from the water to see the Obstinate
+Refusers: where are you going haymaking, neighbours?"
+
+"O, right up above Oxford," said Dick; "it is rather a late country.
+But what share have you got with the Refusers, pretty neighbour?"
+
+Said she, with a laugh: "O, I am the lucky one who doesn't want to
+work; though sometimes I get it, for I serve as model to Mistress
+Philippa there when she wants one: she is our head carver; come and
+see her."
+
+She led us up to the door of the unfinished house, where a rather
+little woman was working with mallet and chisel on the wall near by.
+She seemed very intent on what she was doing, and did not turn round
+when we came up; but a taller woman, quite a girl she seemed, who was
+at work near by, had already knocked off, and was standing looking
+from Clara to Dick with delighted eyes. None of the others paid much
+heed to us.
+
+The blue-clad girl laid her hand on the carver's shoulder and said:
+"Now Philippa, if you gobble up your work like that, you will soon
+have none to do; and what will become of you then?"
+
+The carver turned round hurriedly and showed us the face of a woman
+of forty (or so she seemed), and said rather pettishly, but in a
+sweet voice:
+
+"Don't talk nonsense, Kate, and don't interrupt me if you can help
+it." She stopped short when she saw us, then went on with the kind
+smile of welcome which never failed us. "Thank you for coming to see
+us, neighbours; but I am sure that you won't think me unkind if I go
+on with my work, especially when I tell you that I was ill and unable
+to do anything all through April and May; and this open-air and the
+sun and the work together, and my feeling well again too, make a mere
+delight of every hour to me; and excuse me, I must go on."
+
+She fell to work accordingly on a carving in low relief of flowers
+and figures, but talked on amidst her mallet strokes: "You see, we
+all think this the prettiest place for a house up and down these
+reaches; and the site has been so long encumbered with an unworthy
+one, that we masons were determined to pay off fate and destiny for
+once, and build the prettiest house we could compass here--and so--
+and so--"
+
+Here she lapsed into mere carving, but the tall foreman came up and
+said: "Yes, neighbours, that is it: so it is going to be all ashlar
+because we want to carve a kind of a wreath of flowers and figures
+all round it; and we have been much hindered by one thing or other--
+Philippa's illness amongst others,--and though we could have managed
+our wreath without her--"
+
+"Could you, though?" grumbled the last-named from the face of the
+wall.
+
+"Well, at any rate, she is our best carver, and it would not have
+been kind to begin the carving without her. So you see," said he,
+looking at Dick and me, "we really couldn't go haymaking, could we,
+neighbours? But you see, we are getting on so fast now with this
+splendid weather, that I think we may well spare a week or ten days
+at wheat-harvest; and won't we go at that work then! Come down then
+to the acres that lie north and by west here at our backs and you
+shall see good harvesters, neighbours.
+
+"Hurrah, for a good brag!" called a voice from the scaffold above us;
+"our foreman thinks that an easier job than putting one stone on
+another!"
+
+There was a general laugh at this sally, in which the tall foreman
+joined; and with that we saw a lad bringing out a little table into
+the shadow of the stone-shed, which he set down there, and then going
+back, came out again with the inevitable big wickered flask and tall
+glasses, whereon the foreman led us up to due seats on blocks of
+stone, and said:
+
+"Well, neighbours, drink to my brag coming true, or I shall think you
+don't believe me! Up there!" said he, hailing the scaffold, "are you
+coming down for a glass?" Three of the workmen came running down the
+ladder as men with good "building legs" will do; but the others
+didn't answer, except the joker (if he must so be called), who called
+out without turning round: "Excuse me, neighbours for not getting
+down. I must get on: my work is not superintending, like the
+gaffer's yonder; but, you fellows, send us up a glass to drink the
+haymakers' health." Of course, Philippa would not turn away from her
+beloved work; but the other woman carver came; she turned out to be
+Philippa's daughter, but was a tall strong girl, black-haired and
+gipsey-like of face and curiously solemn of manner. The rest
+gathered round us and clinked glasses, and the men on the scaffold
+turned about and drank to our healths; but the busy little woman by
+the door would have none of it all, but only shrugged her shoulders
+when her daughter came up to her and touched her.
+
+So we shook hands and turned our backs on the Obstinate Refusers,
+went down the slope to our boat, and before we had gone many steps
+heard the full tune of tinkling trowels mingle with the humming of
+the bees and the singing of the larks above the little plain of
+Basildon.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII: THE UPPER WATERS
+
+
+
+We set Walter ashore on the Berkshire side, amidst all the beauties
+of Streatley, and so went our ways into what once would have been the
+deeper country under the foot-hills of the White Horse; and though
+the contrast between half-cocknified and wholly unsophisticated
+country existed no longer, a feeling of exultation rose within me (as
+it used to do) at sight of the familiar and still unchanged hills of
+the Berkshire range.
+
+We stopped at Wallingford for our mid-day meal; of course, all signs
+of squalor and poverty had disappeared from the streets of the
+ancient town, and many ugly houses had been taken down and many
+pretty new ones built, but I thought it curious, that the town still
+looked like the old place I remembered so well; for indeed it looked
+like that ought to have looked.
+
+At dinner we fell in with an old, but very bright and intelligent
+man, who seemed in a country way to be another edition of old
+Hammond. He had an extraordinary detailed knowledge of the ancient
+history of the country-side from the time of Alfred to the days of
+the Parliamentary Wars, many events of which, as you may know, were
+enacted round about Wallingford. But, what was more interesting to
+us, he had detailed record of the period of the change to the present
+state of things, and told us a great deal about it, and especially of
+that exodus of the people from the town to the country, and the
+gradual recovery by the town-bred people on one side, and the
+country-bred people on the other, of those arts of life which they
+had each lost; which loss, as he told us, had at one time gone so far
+that not only was it impossible to find a carpenter or a smith in a
+village or small country town, but that people in such places had
+even forgotten how to bake bread, and that at Wallingford, for
+instance, the bread came down with the newspapers by an early train
+from London, worked in some way, the explanation of which I could not
+understand. He told us also that the townspeople who came into the
+country used to pick up the agricultural arts by carefully watching
+the way in which the machines worked, gathering an idea of handicraft
+from machinery; because at that time almost everything in and about
+the fields was done by elaborate machines used quite unintelligently
+by the labourers. On the other hand, the old men amongst the
+labourers managed to teach the younger ones gradually a little
+artizanship, such as the use of the saw and the plane, the work of
+the smithy, and so forth; for once more, by that time it was as much
+as--or rather, more than--a man could do to fix an ash pole to a rake
+by handiwork; so that it would take a machine worth a thousand
+pounds, a group of workmen, and half a day's travelling, to do five
+shillings' worth of work. He showed us, among other things, an
+account of a certain village council who were working hard at all
+this business; and the record of their intense earnestness in getting
+to the bottom of some matter which in time past would have been
+thought quite trivial, as, for example, the due proportions of alkali
+and oil for soap-making for the village wash, or the exact heat of
+the water into which a leg of mutton should be plunged for boiling--
+all this joined to the utter absence of anything like party feeling,
+which even in a village assembly would certainly have made its
+appearance in an earlier epoch, was very amusing, and at the same
+time instructive.
+
+This old man, whose name was Henry Morsom, took us, after our meal
+and a rest, into a biggish hall which contained a large collection of
+articles of manufacture and art from the last days of the machine
+period to that day; and he went over them with us, and explained them
+with great care. They also were very interesting, showing the
+transition from the makeshift work of the machines (which was at
+about its worst a little after the Civil War before told of) into the
+first years of the new handicraft period. Of course, there was much
+overlapping of the periods: and at first the new handwork came in
+very slowly.
+
+"You must remember," said the old antiquary, "that the handicraft was
+not the result of what used to be called material necessity: on the
+contrary, by that time the machines had been so much improved that
+almost all necessary work might have been done by them: and indeed
+many people at that time, and before it, used to think that machinery
+would entirely supersede handicraft; which certainly, on the face of
+it, seemed more than likely. But there was another opinion, far less
+logical, prevalent amongst the rich people before the days of
+freedom, which did not die out at once after that epoch had begun.
+This opinion, which from all I can learn seemed as natural then, as
+it seems absurd now, was, that while the ordinary daily work of the
+world would be done entirely by automatic machinery, the energies of
+the more intelligent part of mankind would be set free to follow the
+higher forms of the arts, as well as science and the study of
+history. It was strange, was it not, that they should thus ignore
+that aspiration after complete equality which we now recognise as the
+bond of all happy human society?"
+
+I did not answer, but thought the more. Dick looked thoughtful, and
+said:
+
+"Strange, neighbour? Well, I don't know. I have often heard my old
+kinsman say the one aim of all people before our time was to avoid
+work, or at least they thought it was; so of course the work which
+their daily life forced them to do, seemed more like work than that
+which they seemed to choose for themselves."
+
+"True enough," said Morsom. "Anyhow, they soon began to find out
+their mistake, and that only slaves and slaveholders could live
+solely by setting machines going."
+
+Clara broke in here, flushing a little as she spoke: "Was not their
+mistake once more bred of the life of slavery that they had been
+living?--a life which was always looking upon everything, except
+mankind, animate and inanimate--'nature,' as people used to call it--
+as one thing, and mankind as another, it was natural to people
+thinking in this way, that they should try to make 'nature' their
+slave, since they thought 'nature' was something outside them."
+
+"Surely," said Morsom; "and they were puzzled as to what to do, till
+they found the feeling against a mechanical life, which had begun
+before the Great Change amongst people who had leisure to think of
+such things, was spreading insensibly; till at last under the guise
+of pleasure that was not supposed to be work, work that was pleasure
+began to push out the mechanical toil, which they had once hoped at
+the best to reduce to narrow limits indeed, but never to get rid of;
+and which, moreover, they found they could not limit as they had
+hoped to do."
+
+"When did this new revolution gather head?" said I.
+
+"In the half-century that followed the Great Change," said Morsom,
+"it began to be noteworthy; machine after machine was quietly dropped
+under the excuse that the machines could not produce works of art,
+and that works of art were more and more called for. Look here," he
+said, "here are some of the works of that time--rough and unskilful
+in handiwork, but solid and showing some sense of pleasure in the
+making."
+
+"They are very curious," said I, taking up a piece of pottery from
+amongst the specimens which the antiquary was showing us; "not a bit
+like the work of either savages or barbarians, and yet with what
+would once have been called a hatred of civilisation impressed upon
+them."
+
+"Yes," said Morsom, "you must not look for delicacy there: in that
+period you could only have got that from a man who was practically a
+slave. But now, you see," said he, leading me on a little, "we have
+learned the trick of handicraft, and have added the utmost refinement
+of workmanship to the freedom of fancy and imagination."
+
+I looked, and wondered indeed at the deftness and abundance of beauty
+of the work of men who had at last learned to accept life itself as a
+pleasure, and the satisfaction of the common needs of mankind and the
+preparation for them, as work fit for the best of the race. I mused
+silently; but at last I said -
+
+"What is to come after this?"
+
+The old man laughed. "I don't know," said he; "we will meet it when
+it comes."
+
+"Meanwhile," quoth Dick, "we have got to meet the rest of our day's
+journey; so out into the street and down to the strand! Will you
+come a turn with us, neighbour? Our friend is greedy of your
+stories."
+
+"I will go as far as Oxford with you," said he; "I want a book or two
+out of the Bodleian Library. I suppose you will sleep in the old
+city?"
+
+"No," said Dick, "we are going higher up; the hay is waiting us
+there, you know."
+
+Morsom nodded, and we all went into the street together, and got into
+the boat a little above the town bridge. But just as Dick was
+getting the sculls into the rowlocks, the bows of another boat came
+thrusting through the low arch. Even at first sight it was a gay
+little craft indeed--bright green, and painted over with elegantly
+drawn flowers. As it cleared the arch, a figure as bright and gay-
+clad as the boat rose up in it; a slim girl dressed in light blue
+silk that fluttered in the draughty wind of the bridge. I thought I
+knew the figure, and sure enough, as she turned her head to us, and
+showed her beautiful face, I saw with joy that it was none other than
+the fairy godmother from the abundant garden on Runnymede--Ellen, to
+wit.
+
+We all stopped to receive her. Dick rose in the boat and cried out a
+genial good morrow; I tried to be as genial as Dick, but failed;
+Clara waved a delicate hand to her; and Morsom nodded and looked on
+with interest. As to Ellen, the beautiful brown of her face was
+deepened by a flush, as she brought the gunwale of her boat alongside
+ours, and said:
+
+"You see, neighbours, I had some doubt if you would all three come
+back past Runnymede, or if you did, whether you would stop there; and
+besides, I am not sure whether we--my father and I--shall not be away
+in a week or two, for he wants to see a brother of his in the north
+country, and I should not like him to go without me. So I thought I
+might never see you again, and that seemed uncomfortable to me, and--
+and so I came after you."
+
+"Well," said Dick, "I am sure we are all very glad of that; although
+you may be sure that as for Clara and me, we should have made a point
+of coming to see you, and of coming the second time, if we had found
+you away the first. But, dear neighbour, there you are alone in the
+boat, and you have been sculling pretty hard I should think, and
+might find a little quiet sitting pleasant; so we had better part our
+company into two."
+
+"Yes," said Ellen, "I thought you would do that, so I have brought a
+rudder for my boat: will you help me to ship it, please?"
+
+And she went aft in her boat and pushed along our side till she had
+brought the stern close to Dick's hand. He knelt down in our boat
+and she in hers, and the usual fumbling took place over hanging the
+rudder on its hooks; for, as you may imagine, no change had taken
+place in the arrangement of such an unimportant matter as the rudder
+of a pleasure-boat. As the two beautiful young faces bent over the
+rudder, they seemed to me to be very close together, and though it
+only lasted a moment, a sort of pang shot through me as I looked on.
+Clara sat in her place and did not look round, but presently she
+said, with just the least stiffness in her tone:
+
+"How shall we divide? Won't you go into Ellen's boat, Dick, since,
+without offence to our guest, you are the better sculler?"
+
+Dick stood up and laid his hand on her shoulder, and said: "No, no;
+let Guest try what he can do--he ought to be getting into training
+now. Besides, we are in no hurry: we are not going far above
+Oxford; and even if we are benighted, we shall have the moon, which
+will give us nothing worse of a night than a greyer day."
+
+"Besides," said I, "I may manage to do a little more with my sculling
+than merely keeping the boat from drifting down stream."
+
+They all laughed at this, as if it had a been very good joke; and I
+thought that Ellen's laugh, even amongst the others, was one of the
+pleasantest sounds I had ever heard.
+
+To be short, I got into the new-come boat, not a little elated, and
+taking the sculls, set to work to show off a little. For--must I say
+it?--I felt as if even that happy world were made the happier for my
+being so near this strange girl; although I must say that of all the
+persons I had seen in that world renewed, she was the most unfamiliar
+to me, the most unlike what I could have thought of. Clara, for
+instance, beautiful and bright as she was, was not unlike a VERY
+pleasant and unaffected young lady; and the other girls also seemed
+nothing more than specimens of very much improved types which I had
+known in other times. But this girl was not only beautiful with a
+beauty quite different from that of "a young lady," but was in all
+ways so strangely interesting; so that I kept wondering what she
+would say or do next to surprise and please me. Not, indeed, that
+there was anything startling in what she actually said or did; but it
+was all done in a new way, and always with that indefinable interest
+and pleasure of life, which I had noticed more or less in everybody,
+but which in her was more marked and more charming than in anyone
+else that I had seen.
+
+We were soon under way and going at a fair pace through the beautiful
+reaches of the river, between Bensington and Dorchester. It was now
+about the middle of the afternoon, warm rather than hot, and quite
+windless; the clouds high up and light, pearly white, and gleaming,
+softened the sun's burning, but did not hide the pale blue in most
+places, though they seemed to give it height and consistency; the
+sky, in short, looked really like a vault, as poets have sometimes
+called it, and not like mere limitless air, but a vault so vast and
+full of light that it did not in any way oppress the spirits. It was
+the sort of afternoon that Tennyson must have been thinking about,
+when he said of the Lotos-Eaters' land that it was a land where it
+was always afternoon.
+
+Ellen leaned back in the stern and seemed to enjoy herself
+thoroughly. I could see that she was really looking at things and
+let nothing escape her, and as I watched her, an uncomfortable
+feeling that she had been a little touched by love of the deft,
+ready, and handsome Dick, and that she had been constrained to follow
+us because of it, faded out of my mind; since if it had been so, she
+surely could not have been so excitedly pleased, even with the
+beautiful scenes we were passing through. For some time she did not
+say much, but at last, as we had passed under Shillingford Bridge
+(new built, but somewhat on its old lines), she bade me hold the boat
+while she had a good look at the landscape through the graceful arch.
+Then she turned about to me and said:
+
+"I do not know whether to be sorry or glad that this is the first
+time that I have been in these reaches. It is true that it is a
+great pleasure to see all this for the first time; but if I had had a
+year or two of memory of it, how sweetly it would all have mingled
+with my life, waking or dreaming! I am so glad Dick has been pulling
+slowly, so as to linger out the time here. How do you feel about
+your first visit to these waters?"
+
+I do not suppose she meant a trap for me, but anyhow I fell into it,
+and said: "My first visit! It is not my first visit by many a time.
+I know these reaches well; indeed, I may say that I know every yard
+of the Thames from Hammersmith to Cricklade."
+
+I saw the complications that might follow, as her eyes fixed mine
+with a curious look in them, that I had seen before at Runnymede,
+when I had said something which made it difficult for others to
+understand my present position amongst these people. I reddened, and
+said, in order to cover my mistake: "I wonder you have never been up
+so high as this, since you live on the Thames, and moreover row so
+well that it would be no great labour to you. Let alone," quoth I,
+insinuatingly, "that anybody would be glad to row you."
+
+She laughed, clearly not at my compliment (as I am sure she need not
+have done, since it was a very commonplace fact), but at something
+which was stirring in her mind; and she still looked at me kindly,
+but with the above-said keen look in her eyes, and then she said:
+
+"Well, perhaps it is strange, though I have a good deal to do at
+home, what with looking after my father, and dealing with two or
+three young men who have taken a special liking to me, and all of
+whom I cannot please at once. But you, dear neighbour; it seems to
+me stranger that you should know the upper river, than that I should
+not know it; for, as I understand, you have only been in England a
+few days. But perhaps you mean that you have read about it in books,
+and seen pictures of it?--though that does not come to much, either."
+
+"Truly," said I. "Besides, I have not read any books about the
+Thames: it was one of the minor stupidities of our time that no one
+thought fit to write a decent book about what may fairly be called
+our only English river."
+
+The words were no sooner out of my mouth than I saw that I had made
+another mistake; and I felt really annoyed with myself, as I did not
+want to go into a long explanation just then, or begin another series
+of Odyssean lies. Somehow, Ellen seemed to see this, and she took no
+advantage of my slip; her piercing look changed into one of mere
+frank kindness, and she said:
+
+"Well, anyhow I am glad that I am travelling these waters with you,
+since you know our river so well, and I know little of it past
+Pangbourne, for you can tell me all I want to know about it." She
+paused a minute, and then said: "Yet you must understand that the
+part I do know, I know as thoroughly as you do. I should be sorry
+for you to think that I am careless of a thing so beautiful and
+interesting as the Thames."
+
+She said this quite earnestly, and with an air of affectionate appeal
+to me which pleased me very much; but I could see that she was only
+keeping her doubts about me for another time.
+
+Presently we came to Day's Lock, where Dick and his two sitters had
+waited for us. He would have me go ashore, as if to show me
+something which I had never seen before; and nothing loth I followed
+him, Ellen by my side, to the well-remembered Dykes, and the long
+church beyond them, which was still used for various purposes by the
+good folk of Dorchester: where, by the way, the village guest-house
+still had the sign of the Fleur-de-luce which it used to bear in the
+days when hospitality had to be bought and sold. This time, however,
+I made no sign of all this being familiar to me: though as we sat
+for a while on the mound of the Dykes looking up at Sinodun and its
+clear-cut trench, and its sister mamelon of Whittenham, I felt
+somewhat uncomfortable under Ellen's serious attentive look, which
+almost drew from me the cry, "How little anything is changed here!"
+
+We stopped again at Abingdon, which, like Wallingford, was in a way
+both old and new to me, since it had been lifted out of its
+nineteenth-century degradation, and otherwise was as little altered
+as might be.
+
+Sunset was in the sky as we skirted Oxford by Oseney; we stopped a
+minute or two hard by the ancient castle to put Henry Morsom ashore.
+It was a matter of course that so far as they could be seen from the
+river, I missed none of the towers and spires of that once don-
+beridden city; but the meadows all round, which, when I had last
+passed through them, were getting daily more and more squalid, more
+and more impressed with the seal of the "stir and intellectual life
+of the nineteenth century," were no longer intellectual, but had once
+again become as beautiful as they should be, and the little hill of
+Hinksey, with two or three very pretty stone houses new-grown on it
+(I use the word advisedly; for they seemed to belong to it) looked
+down happily on the full streams and waving grass, grey now, but for
+the sunset, with its fast-ripening seeds.
+
+The railway having disappeared, and therewith the various level
+bridges over the streams of Thames, we were soon through Medley Lock
+and in the wide water that washes Port Meadow, with its numerous
+population of geese nowise diminished; and I thought with interest
+how its name and use had survived from the older imperfect communal
+period, through the time of the confused struggle and tyranny of the
+rights of property, into the present rest and happiness of complete
+Communism.
+
+I was taken ashore again at Godstow, to see the remains of the old
+nunnery, pretty nearly in the same condition as I had remembered
+them; and from the high bridge over the cut close by, I could see,
+even in the twilight, how beautiful the little village with its grey
+stone houses had become; for we had now come into the stone-country,
+in which every house must be either built, walls and roof, of grey
+stone or be a blot on the landscape.
+
+We still rowed on after this, Ellen taking the sculls in my boat; we
+passed a weir a little higher up, and about three miles beyond it
+came by moonlight again to a little town, where we slept at a house
+thinly inhabited, as its folk were mostly tented in the hay-fields.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII: THE LITTLE RIVER
+
+
+
+We started before six o'clock the next morning, as we were still
+twenty-five miles from our resting place, and Dick wanted to be there
+before dusk. The journey was pleasant, though to those who do not
+know the upper Thames, there is little to say about it. Ellen and I
+were once more together in her boat, though Dick, for fairness' sake,
+was for having me in his, and letting the two women scull the green
+toy. Ellen, however, would not allow this, but claimed me as the
+interesting person of the company. "After having come so far," said
+she, "I will not be put off with a companion who will be always
+thinking of somebody else than me: the guest is the only person who
+can amuse me properly. I mean that really," said she, turning to me,
+"and have not said it merely as a pretty saying."
+
+Clara blushed and looked very happy at all this; for I think up to
+this time she had been rather frightened of Ellen. As for me I felt
+young again, and strange hopes of my youth were mingling with the
+pleasure of the present; almost destroying it, and quickening it into
+something like pain.
+
+As we passed through the short and winding reaches of the now quickly
+lessening stream, Ellen said: "How pleasant this little river is to
+me, who am used to a great wide wash of water; it almost seems as if
+we shall have to stop at every reach-end. I expect before I get home
+this evening I shall have realised what a little country England is,
+since we can so soon get to the end of its biggest river."
+
+"It is not big," said I, "but it is pretty."
+
+"Yes," she said, "and don't you find it difficult to imagine the
+times when this little pretty country was treated by its folk as if
+it had been an ugly characterless waste, with no delicate beauty to
+be guarded, with no heed taken of the ever fresh pleasure of the
+recurring seasons, and changeful weather, and diverse quality of the
+soil, and so forth? How could people be so cruel to themselves?"
+
+"And to each other," said I. Then a sudden resolution took hold of
+me, and I said: "Dear neighbour, I may as well tell you at once that
+I find it easier to imagine all that ugly past than you do, because I
+myself have been part of it. I see both that you have divined
+something of this in me; and also I think you will believe me when I
+tell you of it, so that I am going to hide nothing from you at all."
+
+She was silent a little, and then she said: "My friend, you have
+guessed right about me; and to tell you the truth I have followed you
+up from Runnymede in order that I might ask you many questions, and
+because I saw that you were not one of us; and that interested and
+pleased me, and I wanted to make you as happy as you could be. To
+say the truth, there was a risk in it," said she, blushing--"I mean
+as to Dick and Clara; for I must tell you, since we are going to be
+such close friends, that even amongst us, where there are so many
+beautiful women, I have often troubled men's minds disastrously.
+That is one reason why I was living alone with my father in the
+cottage at Runnymede. But it did not answer on that score; for of
+course people came there, as the place is not a desert, and they
+seemed to find me all the more interesting for living alone like
+that, and fell to making stories of me to themselves--like I know you
+did, my friend. Well, let that pass. This evening, or to-morrow
+morning, I shall make a proposal to you to do something which would
+please me very much, and I think would not hurt you."
+
+I broke in eagerly, saying that I would do anything in the world for
+her; for indeed, in spite of my years and the too obvious signs of
+them (though that feeling of renewed youth was not a mere passing
+sensation, I think)--in spite of my years, I say, I felt altogether
+too happy in the company of this delightful girl, and was prepared to
+take her confidences for more than they meant perhaps.
+
+She laughed now, but looked very kindly on me. "Well," she said,
+"meantime for the present we will let it be; for I must look at this
+new country that we are passing through. See how the river has
+changed character again: it is broad now, and the reaches are long
+and very slow-running. And look, there is a ferry!"
+
+I told her the name of it, as I slowed off to put the ferry-chain
+over our heads; and on we went passing by a bank clad with oak trees
+on our left hand, till the stream narrowed again and deepened, and we
+rowed on between walls of tall reeds, whose population of reed
+sparrows and warblers were delightfully restless, twittering and
+chuckling as the wash of the boats stirred the reeds from the water
+upwards in the still, hot morning.
+
+She smiled with pleasure, and her lazy enjoyment of the new scene
+seemed to bring out her beauty doubly as she leaned back amidst the
+cushions, though she was far from languid; her idleness being the
+idleness of a person, strong and well-knit both in body and mind,
+deliberately resting.
+
+"Look!" she said, springing up suddenly from her place without any
+obvious effort, and balancing herself with exquisite grace and ease;
+"look at the beautiful old bridge ahead!"
+
+"I need scarcely look at that," said I, not turning my head away from
+her beauty. "I know what it is; though" (with a smile) "we used not
+to call it the Old Bridge time agone."
+
+She looked down upon me kindly, and said, "How well we get on now you
+are no longer on your guard against me!"
+
+And she stood looking thoughtfully at me still, till she had to sit
+down as we passed under the middle one of the row of little pointed
+arches of the oldest bridge across the Thames.
+
+"O the beautiful fields!" she said; "I had no idea of the charm of a
+very small river like this. The smallness of the scale of
+everything, the short reaches, and the speedy change of the banks,
+give one a feeling of going somewhere, of coming to something
+strange, a feeling of adventure which I have not felt in bigger
+waters."
+
+I looked up at her delightedly; for her voice, saying the very thing
+which I was thinking, was like a caress to me. She caught my eye and
+her cheeks reddened under their tan, and she said simply:
+
+"I must tell you, my friend, that when my father leaves the Thames
+this summer he will take me away to a place near the Roman wall in
+Cumberland; so that this voyage of mine is farewell to the south; of
+course with my goodwill in a way; and yet I am sorry for it. I
+hadn't the heart to tell Dick yesterday that we were as good as gone
+from the Thames-side; but somehow to you I must needs tell it."
+
+She stopped and seemed very thoughtful for awhile, and then said
+smiling:
+
+"I must say that I don't like moving about from one home to another;
+one gets so pleasantly used to all the detail of the life about one;
+it fits so harmoniously and happily into one's own life, that
+beginning again, even in a small way, is a kind of pain. But I
+daresay in the country which you come from, you would think this
+petty and unadventurous, and would think the worse of me for it."
+
+She smiled at me caressingly as she spoke, and I made haste to
+answer: "O, no, indeed; again you echo my very thoughts. But I
+hardly expected to hear you speak so. I gathered from all I have
+heard that there was a great deal of changing of abode amongst you in
+this country."
+
+"Well," she said, "of course people are free to move about; but
+except for pleasure-parties, especially in harvest and hay-time, like
+this of ours, I don't think they do so much. I admit that I also
+have other moods than that of stay-at-home, as I hinted just now, and
+I should like to go with you all through the west country--thinking
+of nothing," concluded she smiling.
+
+"I should have plenty to think of," said I.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX: A RESTING-PLACE ON THE UPPER THAMES
+
+
+
+Presently at a place where the river flowed round a headland of the
+meadows, we stopped a while for rest and victuals, and settled
+ourselves on a beautiful bank which almost reached the dignity of a
+hill-side: the wide meadows spread before us, and already the scythe
+was busy amidst the hay. One change I noticed amidst the quiet
+beauty of the fields--to wit, that they were planted with trees here
+and there, often fruit-trees, and that there was none of the
+niggardly begrudging of space to a handsome tree which I remembered
+too well; and though the willows were often polled (or shrowded, as
+they call it in that country-side), this was done with some regard to
+beauty: I mean that there was no polling of rows on rows so as to
+destroy the pleasantness of half a mile of country, but a thoughtful
+sequence in the cutting, that prevented a sudden bareness anywhere.
+To be short, the fields were everywhere treated as a garden made for
+the pleasure as well as the livelihood of all, as old Hammond told me
+was the case.
+
+On this bank or bent of the hill, then, we had our mid-day meal;
+somewhat early for dinner, if that mattered, but we had been stirring
+early: the slender stream of the Thames winding below us between the
+garden of a country I have been telling of; a furlong from us was a
+beautiful little islet begrown with graceful trees; on the slopes
+westward of us was a wood of varied growth overhanging the narrow
+meadow on the south side of the river; while to the north was a wide
+stretch of mead rising very gradually from the river's edge. A
+delicate spire of an ancient building rose up from out of the trees
+in the middle distance, with a few grey houses clustered about it;
+while nearer to us, in fact not half a furlong from the water, was a
+quite modern stone house--a wide quadrangle of one story, the
+buildings that made it being quite low. There was no garden between
+it and the river, nothing but a row of pear-trees still quite young
+and slender; and though there did not seem to be much ornament about
+it, it had a sort of natural elegance, like that of the trees
+themselves.
+
+As we sat looking down on all this in the sweet June day, rather
+happy than merry, Ellen, who sat next me, her hand clasped about one
+knee, leaned sideways to me, and said in a low voice which Dick and
+Clara might have noted if they had not been busy in happy wordless
+love-making: "Friend, in your country were the houses of your field-
+labourers anything like that?"
+
+I said: "Well, at any rate the houses of our rich men were not; they
+were mere blots upon the face of the land."
+
+"I find that hard to understand," she said. "I can see why the
+workmen, who were so oppressed, should not have been able to live in
+beautiful houses; for it takes time and leisure, and minds not over-
+burdened with care, to make beautiful dwellings; and I quite
+understand that these poor people were not allowed to live in such a
+way as to have these (to us) necessary good things. But why the rich
+men, who had the time and the leisure and the materials for building,
+as it would be in this case, should not have housed themselves well,
+I do not understand as yet. I know what you are meaning to say to
+me," she said, looking me full in the eyes and blushing, "to wit that
+their houses and all belonging to them were generally ugly and base,
+unless they chanced to be ancient like yonder remnant of our
+forefathers' work" (pointing to the spire); "that they were--let me
+see; what is the word?"
+
+"Vulgar," said I. "We used to say," said I, "that the ugliness and
+vulgarity of the rich men's dwellings was a necessary reflection from
+the sordidness and bareness of life which they forced upon the poor
+people."
+
+She knit her brows as in thought; then turned a brightened face on
+me, as if she had caught the idea, and said: "Yes, friend, I see
+what you mean. We have sometimes--those of us who look into these
+things--talked this very matter over; because, to say the truth, we
+have plenty of record of the so-called arts of the time before
+Equality of Life; and there are not wanting people who say that the
+state of that society was not the cause of all that ugliness; that
+they were ugly in their life because they liked to be, and could have
+had beautiful things about them if they had chosen; just as a man or
+body of men now may, if they please, make things more or less
+beautiful--Stop! I know what you are going to say."
+
+"Do you?" said I, smiling, yet with a beating heart.
+
+"Yes," she said; "you are answering me, teaching me, in some way or
+another, although you have not spoken the words aloud. You were
+going to say that in times of inequality it was an essential
+condition of the life of these rich men that they should not
+themselves make what they wanted for the adornment of their lives,
+but should force those to make them whom they forced to live pinched
+and sordid lives; and that as a necessary consequence the sordidness
+and pinching, the ugly barrenness of those ruined lives, were worked
+up into the adornment of the lives of the rich, and art died out
+amongst men? Was that what you would say, my friend?"
+
+"Yes, yes," I said, looking at her eagerly; for she had risen and was
+standing on the edge of the bent, the light wind stirring her dainty
+raiment, one hand laid on her bosom, the other arm stretched downward
+and clenched in her earnestness.
+
+"It is true," she said, "it is true! We have proved it true!"
+
+I think amidst my--something more than interest in her, and
+admiration for her, I was beginning to wonder how it would all end.
+I had a glimmering of fear of what might follow; of anxiety as to the
+remedy which this new age might offer for the missing of something
+one might set one's heart on. But now Dick rose to his feet and
+cried out in his hearty manner: "Neighbour Ellen, are you
+quarrelling with the guest, or are you worrying him to tell you
+things which he cannot properly explain to our ignorance?"
+
+"Neither, dear neighbour," she said. "I was so far from quarrelling
+with him that I think I have been making him good friends both with
+himself and me. Is it so, dear guest?" she said, looking down at me
+with a delightful smile of confidence in being understood.
+
+"Indeed it is," said I.
+
+"Well, moreover," she said, "I must say for him that he has explained
+himself to me very well indeed, so that I quite understand him."
+
+"All right," quoth Dick. "When I first set eyes on you at Runnymede
+I knew that there was something wonderful in your keenness of wits.
+I don't say that as a mere pretty speech to please you," said he
+quickly, "but because it is true; and it made me want to see more of
+you. But, come, we ought to be going; for we are not half way, and
+we ought to be in well before sunset."
+
+And therewith he took Clara's hand, and led her down the bent. But
+Ellen stood thoughtfully looking down for a little, and as I took her
+hand to follow Dick, she turned round to me and said:
+
+"You might tell me a great deal and make many things clear to me, if
+you would."
+
+"Yes," said I, "I am pretty well fit for that,--and for nothing else-
+-an old man like me."
+
+She did not notice the bitterness which, whether I liked it or not,
+was in my voice as I spoke, but went on: "It is not so much for
+myself; I should be quite content to dream about past times, and if I
+could not idealise them, yet at least idealise some of the people who
+lived in them. But I think sometimes people are too careless of the
+history of the past--too apt to leave it in the hands of old learned
+men like Hammond. Who knows? Happy as we are, times may alter; we
+may be bitten with some impulse towards change, and many things may
+seem too wonderful for us to resist, too exciting not to catch at, if
+we do not know that they are but phases of what has been before; and
+withal ruinous, deceitful, and sordid."
+
+As we went slowly down toward the boats she said again: "Not for
+myself alone, dear friend; I shall have children; perhaps before the
+end a good many;--I hope so. And though of course I cannot force any
+special kind of knowledge upon them, yet, my Friend, I cannot help
+thinking that just as they might be like me in body, so I might
+impress upon them some part of my ways of thinking; that is, indeed,
+some of the essential part of myself; that part which was not mere
+moods, created by the matters and events round about me. What do you
+think?"
+
+Of one thing I was sure, that her beauty and kindness and eagerness
+combined, forced me to think as she did, when she was not earnestly
+laying herself open to receive my thoughts. I said, what at the time
+was true, that I thought it most important; and presently stood
+entranced by the wonder of her grace as she stepped into the light
+boat, and held out her hand to me. And so on we went up the Thames
+still--or whither?
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX: THE JOURNEY'S END
+
+
+
+On we went. In spite of my new-born excitement about Ellen, and my
+gathering fear of where it would land me, I could not help taking
+abundant interest in the condition of the river and its banks; all
+the more as she never seemed weary of the changing picture, but
+looked at every yard of flowery bank and gurgling eddy with the same
+kind of affectionate interest which I myself once had so fully, as I
+used to think, and perhaps had not altogether lost even in this
+strangely changed society with all its wonders. Ellen seemed
+delighted with my pleasure at this, that, or the other piece of
+carefulness in dealing with the river: the nursing of pretty
+corners; the ingenuity in dealing with difficulties of water-
+engineering, so that the most obviously useful works looked beautiful
+and natural also. All this, I say, pleased me hugely, and she was
+pleased at my pleasure--but rather puzzled too.
+
+"You seem astonished," she said, just after we had passed a mill {2}
+which spanned all the stream save the water-way for traffic, but
+which was as beautiful in its way as a Gothic cathedral--"You seem
+astonished at this being so pleasant to look at."
+
+"Yes," I said, "in a way I am; though I don't see why it should not
+be."
+
+"Ah!" she said, looking at me admiringly, yet with a lurking smile in
+her face, "you know all about the history of the past. Were they not
+always careful about this little stream which now adds so much
+pleasantness to the country side? It would always be easy to manage
+this little river. Ah! I forgot, though," she said, as her eye
+caught mine, "in the days we are thinking of pleasure was wholly
+neglected in such matters. But how did they manage the river in the
+days that you--" Lived in she was going to say; but correcting
+herself, said--"in the days of which you have record?"
+
+"They MISmanaged it," quoth I. "Up to the first half of the
+nineteenth century, when it was still more or less of a highway for
+the country people, some care was taken of the river and its banks;
+and though I don't suppose anyone troubled himself about its aspect,
+yet it was trim and beautiful. But when the railways--of which no
+doubt you have heard--came into power, they would not allow the
+people of the country to use either the natural or artificial
+waterways, of which latter there were a great many. I suppose when
+we get higher up we shall see one of these; a very important one,
+which one of these railways entirely closed to the public, so that
+they might force people to send their goods by their private road,
+and so tax them as heavily as they could."
+
+Ellen laughed heartily. "Well," she said, "that is not stated
+clearly enough in our history-books, and it is worth knowing. But
+certainly the people of those days must have been a curiously lazy
+set. We are not either fidgety or quarrelsome now, but if any one
+tried such a piece of folly on us, we should use the said waterways,
+whoever gaidsaid us: surely that would be simple enough. However, I
+remember other cases of this stupidity: when I was on the Rhine two
+years ago, I remember they showed us ruins of old castles, which,
+according to what we heard, must have been made for pretty much the
+same purpose as the railways were. But I am interrupting your
+history of the river: pray go on."
+
+"It is both short and stupid enough," said I. "The river having lost
+its practical or commercial value--that is, being of no use to make
+money of--"
+
+She nodded. "I understand what that queer phrase means," said she.
+"Go on!"
+
+"Well, it was utterly neglected, till at last it became a nuisance--"
+
+"Yes," quoth Ellen, "I understand: like the railways and the robber
+knights. Yes?"
+
+"So then they turned the makeshift business on to it, and handed it
+over to a body up in London, who from time to time, in order to show
+that they had something to do, did some damage here and there,--cut
+down trees, destroying the banks thereby; dredged the river (where it
+was not needed always), and threw the dredgings on the fields so as
+to spoil them; and so forth. But for the most part they practised
+'masterly inactivity,' as it was then called--that is, they drew
+their salaries, and let things alone."
+
+"Drew their salaries," she said. "I know that means that they were
+allowed to take an extra lot of other people's goods for doing
+nothing. And if that had been all, it really might have been worth
+while to let them do so, if you couldn't find any other way of
+keeping them quiet; but it seems to me that being so paid, they could
+not help doing something, and that something was bound to be
+mischief,--because," said she, kindling with sudden anger, "the whole
+business was founded on lies and false pretensions. I don't mean
+only these river-guardians, but all these master-people I have read
+of."
+
+"Yes," said I, "how happy you are to have got out of the parsimony of
+oppression!"
+
+"Why do you sigh?" she said, kindly and somewhat anxiously. "You
+seem to think that it will not last?"
+
+"It will last for you," quoth I.
+
+"But why not for you?" said she. "Surely it is for all the world;
+and if your country is somewhat backward, it will come into line
+before long. Or," she said quickly, "are you thinking that you must
+soon go back again? I will make my proposal which I told you of at
+once, and so perhaps put an end to your anxiety. I was going to
+propose that you should live with us where we are going. I feel
+quite old friends with you, and should be sorry to lose you." Then
+she smiled on me, and said: "Do you know, I begin to suspect you of
+wanting to nurse a sham sorrow, like the ridiculous characters in
+some of those queer old novels that I have come across now and then."
+
+I really had almost begun to suspect it myself, but I refused to
+admit so much; so I sighed no more, but fell to giving my delightful
+companion what little pieces of history I knew about the river and
+its borderlands; and the time passed pleasantly enough; and between
+the two of us (she was a better sculler than I was, and seemed quite
+tireless) we kept up fairly well with Dick, hot as the afternoon was,
+and swallowed up the way at a great rate. At last we passed under
+another ancient bridge; and through meadows bordered at first with
+huge elm-trees mingled with sweet chestnut of younger but very
+elegant growth; and the meadows widened out so much that it seemed as
+if the trees must now be on the bents only, or about the houses,
+except for the growth of willows on the immediate banks; so that the
+wide stretch of grass was little broken here. Dick got very much
+excited now, and often stood up in the boat to cry out to us that
+this was such and such a field, and so forth; and we caught fire at
+his enthusiasm for the hay-field and its harvest, and pulled our
+best.
+
+At last as we were passing through a reach of the river where on the
+side of the towing-path was a highish bank with a thick whispering
+bed of reeds before it, and on the other side a higher bank, clothed
+with willows that dipped into the stream and crowned by ancient elm-
+trees, we saw bright figures coming along close to the bank, as if
+they were looking for something; as, indeed, they were, and we--that
+is, Dick and his company--were what they were looking for. Dick lay
+on his oars, and we followed his example. He gave a joyous shout to
+the people on the bank, which was echoed back from it in many voices,
+deep and sweetly shrill; for there were above a dozen persons, both
+men, women, and children. A tall handsome woman, with black wavy
+hair and deep-set grey eyes, came forward on the bank and waved her
+hand gracefully to us, and said:
+
+"Dick, my friend, we have almost had to wait for you! What excuse
+have you to make for your slavish punctuality? Why didn't you take
+us by surprise, and come yesterday?"
+
+"O," said Dick, with an almost imperceptible jerk of his head toward
+our boat, "we didn't want to come too quick up the water; there is so
+much to see for those who have not been up here before."
+
+"True, true," said the stately lady, for stately is the word that
+must be used for her; "and we want them to get to know the wet way
+from the east thoroughly well, since they must often use it now. But
+come ashore at once, Dick, and you, dear neighbours; there is a break
+in the reeds and a good landing-place just round the corner. We can
+carry up your things, or send some of the lads after them."
+
+"No, no," said Dick; "it is easier going by water, though it is but a
+step. Besides, I want to bring my friend here to the proper place.
+We will go on to the Ford; and you can talk to us from the bank as we
+paddle along."
+
+He pulled his sculls through the water, and on we went, turning a
+sharp angle and going north a little. Presently we saw before us a
+bank of elm-trees, which told us of a house amidst them, though I
+looked in vain for the grey walls that I expected to see there. As
+we went, the folk on the bank talked indeed, mingling their kind
+voices with the cuckoo's song, the sweet strong whistle of the
+blackbirds, and the ceaseless note of the corn-crake as he crept
+through the long grass of the mowing-field; whence came waves of
+fragrance from the flowering clover amidst of the ripe grass.
+
+In a few minutes we had passed through a deep eddying pool into the
+sharp stream that ran from the ford, and beached our craft on a tiny
+strand of limestone-gravel, and stepped ashore into the arms of our
+up-river friends, our journey done.
+
+I disentangled myself from the merry throng, and mounting on the
+cart-road that ran along the river some feet above the water, I
+looked round about me. The river came down through a wide meadow on
+my left, which was grey now with the ripened seeding grasses; the
+gleaming water was lost presently by a turn of the bank, but over the
+meadow I could see the mingled gables of a building where I knew the
+lock must be, and which now seemed to combine a mill with it. A low
+wooded ridge bounded the river-plain to the south and south-east,
+whence we had come, and a few low houses lay about its feet and up
+its slope. I turned a little to my right, and through the hawthorn
+sprays and long shoots of the wild roses could see the flat country
+spreading out far away under the sun of the calm evening, till
+something that might be called hills with a look of sheep-pastures
+about them bounded it with a soft blue line. Before me, the elm-
+boughs still hid most of what houses there might be in this river-
+side dwelling of men; but to the right of the cart-road a few grey
+buildings of the simplest kind showed here and there.
+
+There I stood in a dreamy mood, and rubbed my eyes as if I were not
+wholly awake, and half expected to see the gay-clad company of
+beautiful men and women change to two or three spindle-legged back-
+bowed men and haggard, hollow-eyed, ill-favoured women, who once wore
+down the soil of this land with their heavy hopeless feet, from day
+to day, and season to season, and year to year. But no change came
+as yet, and my heart swelled with joy as I thought of all the
+beautiful grey villages, from the river to the plain and the plain to
+the uplands, which I could picture to myself so well, all peopled now
+with this happy and lovely folk, who had cast away riches and
+attained to wealth.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI: AN OLD HOUSE AMONGST NEW FOLK
+
+
+
+As I stood there Ellen detached herself from our happy friends who
+still stood on the little strand and came up to me. She took me by
+the hand, and said softly, "Take me on to the house at once; we need
+not wait for the others: I had rather not."
+
+I had a mind to say that I did not know the way thither, and that the
+river-side dwellers should lead; but almost without my will my feet
+moved on along the road they knew. The raised way led us into a
+little field bounded by a backwater of the river on one side; on the
+right hand we could see a cluster of small houses and barns, new and
+old, and before us a grey stone barn and a wall partly overgrown with
+ivy, over which a few grey gables showed. The village road ended in
+the shallow of the aforesaid backwater. We crossed the road, and
+again almost without my will my hand raised the latch of a door in
+the wall, and we stood presently on a stone path which led up to the
+old house to which fate in the shape of Dick had so strangely brought
+me in this new world of men. My companion gave a sigh of pleased
+surprise and enjoyment; nor did I wonder, for the garden between the
+wall and the house was redolent of the June flowers, and the roses
+were rolling over one another with that delicious superabundance of
+small well-tended gardens which at first sight takes away all thought
+from the beholder save that of beauty. The blackbirds were singing
+their loudest, the doves were cooing on the roof-ridge, the rooks in
+the high elm-trees beyond were garrulous among the young leaves, and
+the swifts wheeled whining about the gables. And the house itself
+was a fit guardian for all the beauty of this heart of summer.
+
+Once again Ellen echoed my thoughts as she said:
+
+"Yes, friend, this is what I came out for to see; this many-gabled
+old house built by the simple country-folk of the long-past times,
+regardless of all the turmoil that was going on in cities and courts,
+is lovely still amidst all the beauty which these latter days have
+created; and I do not wonder at our friends tending it carefully and
+making much of it. It seems to me as if it had waited for these
+happy days, and held in it the gathered crumbs of happiness of the
+confused and turbulent past."
+
+She led me up close to the house, and laid her shapely sun-browned
+hand and arm on the lichened wall as if to embrace it, and cried out,
+"O me! O me! How I love the earth, and the seasons, and weather,
+and all things that deal with it, and all that grows out of it,--as
+this has done!"
+
+I could not answer her, or say a word. Her exultation and pleasure
+were so keen and exquisite, and her beauty, so delicate, yet so
+interfused with energy, expressed it so fully, that any added word
+would have been commonplace and futile. I dreaded lest the others
+should come in suddenly and break the spell she had cast about me;
+but we stood there a while by the corner of the big gable of the
+house, and no one came. I heard the merry voices some way off
+presently, and knew that they were going along the river to the great
+meadow on the other side of the house and garden.
+
+We drew back a little, and looked up at the house: the door and the
+windows were open to the fragrant sun-cured air; from the upper
+window-sills hung festoons of flowers in honour of the festival, as
+if the others shared in the love for the old house.
+
+"Come in," said Ellen. "I hope nothing will spoil it inside; but I
+don't think it will. Come! we must go back presently to the others.
+They have gone on to the tents; for surely they must have tents
+pitched for the haymakers--the house would not hold a tithe of the
+folk, I am sure."
+
+She led me on to the door, murmuring little above her breath as she
+did so, "The earth and the growth of it and the life of it! If I
+could but say or show how I love it!"
+
+We went in, and found no soul in any room as we wandered from room to
+room,--from the rose-covered porch to the strange and quaint garrets
+amongst the great timbers of the roof, where of old time the tillers
+and herdsmen of the manor slept, but which a-nights seemed now, by
+the small size of the beds, and the litter of useless and disregarded
+matters--bunches of dying flowers, feathers of birds, shells of
+starling's eggs, caddis worms in mugs, and the like--seemed to be
+inhabited for the time by children.
+
+Everywhere there was but little furniture, and that only the most
+necessary, and of the simplest forms. The extravagant love of
+ornament which I had noted in this people elsewhere seemed here to
+have given place to the feeling that the house itself and its
+associations was the ornament of the country life amidst which it had
+been left stranded from old times, and that to re-ornament it would
+but take away its use as a piece of natural beauty.
+
+We sat down at last in a room over the wall which Ellen had caressed,
+and which was still hung with old tapestry, originally of no artistic
+value, but now faded into pleasant grey tones which harmonised
+thoroughly well with the quiet of the place, and which would have
+been ill supplanted by brighter and more striking decoration.
+
+I asked a few random questions of Ellen as we sat there, but scarcely
+listened to her answers, and presently became silent, and then scarce
+conscious of anything, but that I was there in that old room, the
+doves crooning from the roofs of the barn and dovecot beyond the
+window opposite to me.
+
+My thought returned to me after what I think was but a minute or two,
+but which, as in a vivid dream, seemed as if it had lasted a long
+time, when I saw Ellen sitting, looking all the fuller of life and
+pleasure and desire from the contrast with the grey faded tapestry
+with its futile design, which was now only bearable because it had
+grown so faint and feeble.
+
+She looked at me kindly, but as if she read me through and through.
+She said: "You have begun again your never-ending contrast between
+the past and this present. Is it not so?"
+
+"True," said I. "I was thinking of what you, with your capacity and
+intelligence, joined to your love of pleasure, and your impatience of
+unreasonable restraint--of what you would have been in that past.
+And even now, when all is won and has been for a long time, my heart
+is sickened with thinking of all the waste of life that has gone on
+for so many years."
+
+"So many centuries," she said, "so many ages!"
+
+"True," I said; "too true," and sat silent again.
+
+She rose up and said: "Come, I must not let you go off into a dream
+again so soon. If we must lose you, I want you to see all that you
+can see first before you go back again."
+
+"Lose me?" I said--"go back again? Am I not to go up to the North
+with you? What do you mean?"
+
+She smiled somewhat sadly, and said: "Not yet; we will not talk of
+that yet. Only, what were you thinking of just now?"
+
+I said falteringly: "I was saying to myself, The past, the present?
+Should she not have said the contrast of the present with the future:
+of blind despair with hope?"
+
+"I knew it," she said. Then she caught my hand and said excitedly,
+"Come, while there is yet time! Come!" And she led me out of the
+room; and as we were going downstairs and out of the house into the
+garden by a little side door which opened out of a curious lobby, she
+said in a calm voice, as if she wished me to forget her sudden
+nervousness: "Come! we ought to join the others before they come
+here looking for us. And let me tell you, my friend, that I can see
+you are too apt to fall into mere dreamy musing: no doubt because
+you are not yet used to our life of repose amidst of energy; of work
+which is pleasure and pleasure which is work."
+
+She paused a little, and as we came out into the lovely garden again,
+she said: "My friend, you were saying that you wondered what I
+should have been if I had lived in those past days of turmoil and
+oppression. Well, I think I have studied the history of them to know
+pretty well. I should have been one of the poor, for my father when
+he was working was a mere tiller of the soil. Well, I could not have
+borne that; therefore my beauty and cleverness and brightness" (she
+spoke with no blush or simper of false shame) "would have been sold
+to rich men, and my life would have been wasted indeed; for I know
+enough of that to know that I should have had no choice, no power of
+will over my life; and that I should never have bought pleasure from
+the rich men, or even opportunity of action, whereby I might have won
+some true excitement. I should have wrecked and wasted in one way or
+another, either by penury or by luxury. Is it not so?"
+
+"Indeed it is," said I.
+
+She was going to say something else, when a little gate in the fence,
+which led into a small elm-shaded field, was opened, and Dick came
+with hasty cheerfulness up the garden path, and was presently
+standing between us, a hand laid on the shoulder of each. He said:
+"Well, neighbours, I thought you two would like to see the old house
+quietly without a crowd in it. Isn't it a jewel of a house after its
+kind? Well, come along, for it is getting towards dinner-time.
+Perhaps you, guest, would like a swim before we sit down to what I
+fancy will be a pretty long feast?"
+
+"Yes," I said, "I should like that."
+
+"Well, good-bye for the present, neighbour Ellen," said Dick. "Here
+comes Clara to take care of you, as I fancy she is more at home
+amongst our friends here."
+
+Clara came out of the fields as he spoke; and with one look at Ellen
+I turned and went with Dick, doubting, if I must say the truth,
+whether I should see her again.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII: THE FEAST'S BEGINNING--THE END
+
+
+
+Dick brought me at once into the little field which, as I had seen
+from the garden, was covered with gaily-coloured tents arranged in
+orderly lanes, about which were sitting and lying on the grass some
+fifty or sixty men, women, and children, all of them in the height of
+good temper and enjoyment--with their holiday mood on, so to say.
+
+"You are thinking that we don't make a great show as to numbers,"
+said Dick; "but you must remember that we shall have more to-morrow;
+because in this haymaking work there is room for a great many people
+who are not over-skilled in country matters: and there are many who
+lead sedentary lives, whom it would be unkind to deprive of their
+pleasure in the hay-field--scientific men and close students
+generally: so that the skilled workmen, outside those who are wanted
+as mowers, and foremen of the haymaking, stand aside, and take a
+little downright rest, which you know is good for them, whether they
+like it or not: or else they go to other countrysides, as I am doing
+here. You see, the scientific men and historians, and students
+generally, will not be wanted till we are fairly in the midst of the
+tedding, which of course will not be till the day after to-morrow."
+With that he brought me out of the little field on to a kind of
+causeway above the river-side meadow, and thence turning to the left
+on to a path through the mowing grass, which was thick and very tall,
+led on till we came to the river above the weir and its mill. There
+we had a delightful swim in the broad piece of water above the lock,
+where the river looked much bigger than its natural size from its
+being dammed up by the weir.
+
+"Now we are in a fit mood for dinner," said Dick, when we had dressed
+and were going through the grass again; "and certainly of all the
+cheerful meals in the year, this one of haysel is the cheerfullest;
+not even excepting the corn-harvest feast; for then the year is
+beginning to fail, and one cannot help having a feeling behind all
+the gaiety, of the coming of the dark days, and the shorn fields and
+empty gardens; and the spring is almost too far off to look forward
+to. It is, then, in the autumn, when one almost believes in death."
+
+"How strangely you talk," said I, "of such a constantly recurring and
+consequently commonplace matter as the sequence of the seasons." And
+indeed these people were like children about such things, and had
+what seemed to me a quite exaggerated interest in the weather, a fine
+day, a dark night, or a brilliant one, and the like.
+
+"Strangely?" said he. "Is it strange to sympathise with the year and
+its gains and losses?"
+
+"At any rate," said I, "if you look upon the course of the year as a
+beautiful and interesting drama, which is what I think you do, you
+should be as much pleased and interested with the winter and its
+trouble and pain as with this wonderful summer luxury."
+
+"And am I not?" said Dick, rather warmly; "only I can't look upon it
+as if I were sitting in a theatre seeing the play going on before me,
+myself taking no part of it. It is difficult," said he, smiling
+good-humouredly, "for a non-literary man like me to explain myself
+properly, like that dear girl Ellen would; but I mean that I am part
+of it all, and feel the pain as well as the pleasure in my own
+person. It is not done for me by somebody else, merely that I may
+eat and drink and sleep; but I myself do my share of it."
+
+In his way also, as Ellen in hers, I could see that Dick had that
+passionate love of the earth which was common to but few people at
+least, in the days I knew; in which the prevailing feeling amongst
+intellectual persons was a kind of sour distaste for the changing
+drama of the year, for the life of earth and its dealings with men.
+Indeed, in those days it was thought poetic and imaginative to look
+upon life as a thing to be borne, rather than enjoyed.
+
+So I mused till Dick's laugh brought me back into the Oxfordshire
+hay-fields. "One thing seems strange to me," said he--"that I must
+needs trouble myself about the winter and its scantiness, in the
+midst of the summer abundance. If it hadn't happened to me before, I
+should have thought it was your doing, guest; that you had thrown a
+kind of evil charm over me. Now, you know," said he, suddenly,
+"that's only a joke, so you mustn't take it to heart."
+
+"All right," said I; "I don't." Yet I did feel somewhat uneasy at
+his words, after all.
+
+We crossed the causeway this time, and did not turn back to the
+house, but went along a path beside a field of wheat now almost ready
+to blossom. I said:
+
+"We do not dine in the house or garden, then?--as indeed I did not
+expect to do. Where do we meet, then? For I can see that the houses
+are mostly very small."
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "you are right, they are small in this country-
+side: there are so many good old houses left, that people dwell a
+good deal in such small detached houses. As to our dinner, we are
+going to have our feast in the church. I wish, for your sake, it
+were as big and handsome as that of the old Roman town to the west,
+or the forest town to the north; {3} but, however, it will hold us
+all; and though it is a little thing, it is beautiful in its way."
+
+This was somewhat new to me, this dinner in a church, and I thought
+of the church-ales of the Middle Ages; but I said nothing, and
+presently we came out into the road which ran through the village.
+Dick looked up and down it, and seeing only two straggling groups
+before us, said: "It seems as if we must be somewhat late; they are
+all gone on; and they will be sure to make a point of waiting for
+you, as the guest of guests, since you come from so far."
+
+He hastened as he spoke, and I kept up with him, and presently we
+came to a little avenue of lime-trees which led us straight to the
+church porch, from whose open door came the sound of cheerful voices
+and laughter, and varied merriment.
+
+"Yes," said Dick, "it's the coolest place for one thing, this hot
+evening. Come along; they will be glad to see you."
+
+Indeed, in spite of my bath, I felt the weather more sultry and
+oppressive than on any day of our journey yet.
+
+We went into the church, which was a simple little building with one
+little aisle divided from the nave by three round arches, a chancel,
+and a rather roomy transept for so small a building, the windows
+mostly of the graceful Oxfordshire fourteenth century type. There
+was no modern architectural decoration in it; it looked, indeed, as
+if none had been attempted since the Puritans whitewashed the
+mediaeval saints and histories on the wall. It was, however, gaily
+dressed up for this latter-day festival, with festoons of flowers
+from arch to arch, and great pitchers of flowers standing about on
+the floor; while under the west window hung two cross scythes, their
+blades polished white, and gleaming from out of the flowers that
+wreathed them. But its best ornament was the crowd of handsome,
+happy-looking men and women that were set down to table, and who,
+with their bright faces and rich hair over their gay holiday raiment,
+looked, as the Persian poet puts it, like a bed of tulips in the sun.
+Though the church was a small one, there was plenty of room; for a
+small church makes a biggish house; and on this evening there was no
+need to set cross tables along the transepts; though doubtless these
+would be wanted next day, when the learned men of whom Dick has been
+speaking should be come to take their more humble part in the
+haymaking.
+
+I stood on the threshold with the expectant smile on my face of a man
+who is going to take part in a festivity which he is really prepared
+to enjoy. Dick, standing by me was looking round the company with an
+air of proprietorship in them, I thought. Opposite me sat Clara and
+Ellen, with Dick's place open between them: they were smiling, but
+their beautiful faces were each turned towards the neighbours on
+either side, who were talking to them, and they did not seem to see
+me. I turned to Dick, expecting him to lead me forward, and he
+turned his face to me; but strange to say, though it was as smiling
+and cheerful as ever, it made no response to my glance--nay, he
+seemed to take no heed at all of my presence, and I noticed that none
+of the company looked at me. A pang shot through me, as of some
+disaster long expected and suddenly realised. Dick moved on a little
+without a word to me. I was not three yards from the two women who,
+though they had been my companions for such a short time, had really,
+as I thought, become my friends. Clara's face was turned full upon
+me now, but she also did not seem to see me, though I know I was
+trying to catch her eye with an appealing look. I turned to Ellen,
+and she DID seem to recognise me for an instant; but her bright face
+turned sad directly, and she shook her head with a mournful look, and
+the next moment all consciousness of my presence had faded from her
+face.
+
+I felt lonely and sick at heart past the power of words to describe.
+I hung about a minute longer, and then turned and went out of the
+porch again and through the lime-avenue into the road, while the
+blackbirds sang their strongest from the bushes about me in the hot
+June evening.
+
+Once more without any conscious effort of will I set my face toward
+the old house by the ford, but as I turned round the corner which led
+to the remains of the village cross, I came upon a figure strangely
+contrasting with the joyous, beautiful people I had left behind in
+the church. It was a man who looked old, but whom I knew from habit,
+now half forgotten, was really not much more than fifty. His face
+was rugged, and grimed rather than dirty; his eyes dull and bleared;
+his body bent, his calves thin and spindly, his feet dragging and
+limping. His clothing was a mixture of dirt and rags long over-
+familiar to me. As I passed him he touched his hat with some real
+goodwill and courtesy, and much servility.
+
+Inexpressibly shocked, I hurried past him and hastened along the road
+that led to the river and the lower end of the village; but suddenly
+I saw as it were a black cloud rolling along to meet me, like a
+nightmare of my childish days; and for a while I was conscious of
+nothing else than being in the dark, and whether I was walking, or
+sitting, or lying down, I could not tell.
+
+* * *
+
+I lay in my bed in my house at dingy Hammersmith thinking about it
+all; and trying to consider if I was overwhelmed with despair at
+finding I had been dreaming a dream; and strange to say, I found that
+I was not so despairing.
+
+Or indeed WAS it a dream? If so, why was I so conscious all along
+that I was really seeing all that new life from the outside, still
+wrapped up in the prejudices, the anxieties, the distrust of this
+time of doubt and struggle?
+
+All along, though those friends were so real to me, I had been
+feeling as if I had no business amongst them: as though the time
+would come when they would reject me, and say, as Ellen's last
+mournful look seemed to say, "No, it will not do; you cannot be of
+us; you belong so entirely to the unhappiness of the past that our
+happiness even would weary you. Go back again, now you have seen us,
+and your outward eyes have learned that in spite of all the
+infallible maxims of your day there is yet a time of rest in store
+for the world, when mastery has changed into fellowship--but not
+before. Go back again, then, and while you live you will see all
+round you people engaged in making others live lives which are not
+their own, while they themselves care nothing for their own real
+lives--men who hate life though they fear death. Go back and be the
+happier for having seen us, for having added a little hope to your
+struggle. Go on living while you may, striving, with whatsoever pain
+and labour needs must be, to build up little by little the new day of
+fellowship, and rest, and happiness."
+
+Yes, surely! and if others can see it as I have seen it, then it may
+be called a vision rather than a dream.
+
+
+
+Footnotes:
+
+{1} "Elegant," I mean, as a Persian pattern is elegant; not like a
+rich "elegant" lady out for a morning call. I should rather call
+that genteel.
+
+{2} I should have said that all along the Thames there were
+abundance of mills used for various purposes; none of which were in
+any degree unsightly, and many strikingly beautiful; and the gardens
+about them marvels of loveliness.
+
+{3} Cirencester and Burford he must have meant.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg Etext of News from Nowhere, by William Morris
+
diff --git a/old/nwsnw10.zip b/old/nwsnw10.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fa7717d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/nwsnw10.zip
Binary files differ